blob: d13ab3a2d96db324f2ca914ee7f5903caaef6943 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau02c7c142012-06-04 00:43:45 +02007 2012/06/04
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100565. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
586. HTTP header manipulation
59
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100607. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200617.1. Matching integers
627.2. Matching strings
637.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200647.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200657.5. Available matching criteria
667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
697.6. Pre-defined ACLs
707.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100717.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072
738. Logging
748.1. Log levels
758.2. Log formats
768.2.1. Default log format
778.2.2. TCP log format
788.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100798.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200808.3. Advanced logging options
818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
858.4. Timing events
868.5. Session state at disconnection
878.6. Non-printable characters
888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
908.9. Examples of logs
91
929. Statistics and monitoring
939.1. CSV format
949.2. Unix Socket commands
95
96
971. Quick reminder about HTTP
98----------------------------
99
100When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
101fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
102on almost anything found in the contents.
103
104However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
105formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
106correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
107
108
1091.1. The HTTP transaction model
110-------------------------------
111
112The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100113to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
115connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
116will involve a new connection :
117
118 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
119
120In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
121establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
122by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
123length.
124
125Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
126to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
127however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
128response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
129header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
130
131 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
132
133Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
134power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
135but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200136a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
138A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
139keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
140second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
141page :
142
143 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
144
145This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
146latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
147correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
148the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100149server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
152connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
153everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
154established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
155sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
156while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
157another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
158sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
159http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
160mode.
161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162
1631.2. HTTP request
164-----------------
165
166First, let's consider this HTTP request :
167
168 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100169 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
171 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
172 3 User-agent: my small browser
173 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
174 5 Accept: image/png
175
176
1771.2.1. The Request line
178-----------------------
179
180Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
181
182 - a METHOD : GET
183 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
184 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
185
186All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
187which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
188followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
189is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
190desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
191the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
192
193The URI itself can have several forms :
194
195 - A "relative URI" :
196
197 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
198
199 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
200 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
201
202 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
203
204 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
207 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
208 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
209 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
210 must accept this form too.
211
212 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
213 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
214 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
217 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
218 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
219 other protocols too.
220
221In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
222mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
223on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
224It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
225specific to the language, framework or application in use.
226
227
2281.2.2. The request headers
229--------------------------
230
231The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
232beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
233an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
234Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
235values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
236encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
237the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
238define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
239
240Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
241their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
242"Connection:" header).
243
244The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
245that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
246is one valid form of empty line.
247
248Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
249headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
250about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
251application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
252
253Important note:
254 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
255 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
256 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
257 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
258
259
2601.3. HTTP response
261------------------
262
263An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
264messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
265
266 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100267 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200268 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
269 2 Content-length: 350
270 3 Content-Type: text/html
271
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200272As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
273codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
274response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100275continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
276the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
277following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
278sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
279(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
280correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
281such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
282state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
283over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
284if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
285information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.3.1. The Response line
289------------------------
290
291Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
292
293 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
294 - a status code : 200
295 - a reason : OK
296
297The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
300 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
301 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
302 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
303
304Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100305"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
307messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
308or "Authentication Required".
309
310Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
311
312 Code When / reason
313 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
314 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 400 for an invalid or too large request
318 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
319 accessing the stats page)
320 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
321 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
322 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
323 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
324 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
325 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
326 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
327 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
328 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
329
330The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3314.2).
332
333
3341.3.2. The response headers
335---------------------------
336
337Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
338the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
339details.
340
341
3422. Configuring HAProxy
343----------------------
344
3452.1. Configuration file format
346------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200347
348HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
349
350 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
351 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
352 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
353 "frontend" and "backend".
354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100355The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
356referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
357delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100358preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100359escaped by doubling them.
360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
3622.2. Time format
363----------------
364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100365Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
367otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
368numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
369for every keyword. Supported units are :
370
371 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
372 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
373 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
374 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
375 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
376 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
377
378
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003792.3. Examples
380-------------
381
382 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
383 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
384 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
385 global
386 daemon
387 maxconn 256
388
389 defaults
390 mode http
391 timeout connect 5000ms
392 timeout client 50000ms
393 timeout server 50000ms
394
395 frontend http-in
396 bind *:80
397 default_backend servers
398
399 backend servers
400 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
401
402
403 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
404 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
405 global
406 daemon
407 maxconn 256
408
409 defaults
410 mode http
411 timeout connect 5000ms
412 timeout client 50000ms
413 timeout server 50000ms
414
415 listen http-in
416 bind *:80
417 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
418
419
420Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
421
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100422 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200423
424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426--------------------
427
428Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
429are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
430of them have command-line equivalents.
431
432The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
433
434 * Process management and security
435 - chroot
436 - daemon
437 - gid
438 - group
439 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100440 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - nbproc
442 - pidfile
443 - uid
444 - ulimit-n
445 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200446 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200447 - node
448 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100449 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 * Performance tuning
452 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200453 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - noepoll
456 - nokqueue
457 - nopoll
458 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100459 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200460 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200461 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200462 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200463 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100464 - tune.maxaccept
465 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200467 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100468 - tune.rcvbuf.client
469 - tune.rcvbuf.server
470 - tune.sndbuf.client
471 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100472
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200473 * Debugging
474 - debug
475 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476
477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004783.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200479------------------------------------
480
481chroot <jail dir>
482 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
483 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
484 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
485 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
486 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
487 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200489daemon
490 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
491 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
492 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
493
494gid <number>
495 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
496 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
497 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
498 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500group <group name>
501 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
502 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200504log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
506 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 configured with "log global".
508
509 <address> can be one of:
510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100511 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100512 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
513 port).
514
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100515 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
516 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
517 port).
518
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100519 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
520 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
521 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
522 writeable).
523
524 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525
526 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
527 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
528 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
529
530 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200531 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
532 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
533 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
534 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
535 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
536 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200538 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540log-send-hostname [<string>]
541 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
542 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
543 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
544 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
545 the logs.
546
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000547log-tag <string>
548 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
549 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
550 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
551 running on the same host.
552
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200553nbproc <number>
554 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
555 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
556 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
557 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
558 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
559
560pidfile <pidfile>
561 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
562 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
563 starting the process. See also "daemon".
564
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200565stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200566 [level <level>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200567
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200568 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
569 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100570 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200571 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
572
573 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
574 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
575 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
576 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
577 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
578
579 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200580 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200581 counters).
582
583 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
584 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100585
586 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
587 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
588 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
589 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
590 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
591 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
592 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
595 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
596 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100597 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200598
599stats maxconn <connections>
600 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
601 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603uid <number>
604 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
605 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
606 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
607 one. See also "gid" and "user".
608
609ulimit-n <number>
610 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
611 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
612 option.
613
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
615 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
616
617 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
618 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
619 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
620 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
621 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
622 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
623 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
624 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
625 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
626 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628user <user name>
629 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
630 See also "uid" and "group".
631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200632node <name>
633 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
634
635 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
636 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
637 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
638 traffic.
639
640description <text>
641 Add a text that describes the instance.
642
643 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
644 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
645 "<" and ">" characters.
646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006483.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649-----------------------
650
651maxconn <number>
652 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
653 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
654 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
655 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
656
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200657maxconnrate <number>
658 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
659 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
660 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
661 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
662 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
663 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
664 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
665 fairness.
666
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100667maxpipes <number>
668 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
669 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
670 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
671 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
672 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
673 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675noepoll
676 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
677 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
678 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
679
680nokqueue
681 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
682 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
683 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
684
685nopoll
686 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
687 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100688 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
690 "nokqueue".
691
692nosepoll
693 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
694 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
695 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
696
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100697nosplice
698 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
699 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
700 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100701 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100702 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
703 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
704 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
705 "option splice-response".
706
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200707spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
708 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
709 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
710 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
711 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
712 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
713
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200714tune.bufsize <number>
715 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
716 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
717 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
718 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
719 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
720 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
721 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
722 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
723
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200724tune.chksize <number>
725 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
726 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
727 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
728 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
729 checks whenever possible.
730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
739 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
740 limit too high.
741
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100742tune.maxaccept <number>
743 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
744 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
745 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100746 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100747 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
748 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100749 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100750 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
751
752tune.maxpollevents <number>
753 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
754 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
755 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
756 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
757 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
758
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200759tune.maxrewrite <number>
760 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
761 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
762 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
763 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
764 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
765 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
766 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
767 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
768 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
769 bufsize.
770
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200771tune.pipesize <number>
772 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
773 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
774 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
775 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
776 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
777 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
778
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100779tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
780tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
781 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
782 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
783 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
784 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
785 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
786 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
787 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
788
789tune.sndbuf.client <number>
790tune.sndbuf.server <number>
791 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
792 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
793 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
794 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
795 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
796 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
797 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
798 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
799 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
800 notifying haproxy again.
801
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008033.3. Debugging
804--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805
806debug
807 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
808 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
809 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
810 system startup.
811
812quiet
813 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
814 line argument "-q".
815
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008173.4. Userlists
818--------------
819It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
820http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
821it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
822
823userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100824 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100825 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
826
827group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100828 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100829 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
830 proceeded by "users" keyword.
831
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100832user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
833 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100834 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
835 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100836 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
837 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100838 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
839 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
840
841
842 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100843 userlist L1
844 group G1 users tiger,scott
845 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100846
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100847 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
848 user scott insecure-password elgato
849 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100850
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100851 userlist L2
852 group G1
853 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100854
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100855 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
856 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
857 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100858
859 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200861
8623.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200863----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200864It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
865haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
866pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
867identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
868or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
869Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
870known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
871the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
872process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
873during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
874tables.
875
876peers <peersect>
877 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
878 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
879
880peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
881 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
882 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
883 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
884 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
885 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
886 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
887
888 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
889 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
890
891 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
892 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
893 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
894 across all peers.
895
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200896 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200897 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100898 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
899 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
900 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200901
902 backend mybackend
903 mode tcp
904 balance roundrobin
905 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
906 stick on src
907
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100908 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
909 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200910
911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009124. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
916 - defaults <name>
917 - frontend <name>
918 - backend <name>
919 - listen <name>
920
921A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
922its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
923section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200925
926A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
927connections.
928
929A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
930to forward incoming connections.
931
932A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
933parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100935All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
936'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
937case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
938
939Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
940logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
941proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
942However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
943name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
944
945Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
946and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100947bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100948protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
949modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
950arbitrary criteria.
951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
954--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200956The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
957limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
958they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
959limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200961option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200962and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
963with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
964specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100967 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
968------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
969acl - X X X
970appsession - - X X
971backlog X X X -
972balance X - X X
973bind - X X -
974bind-process X X X X
975block - X X X
976capture cookie - X X -
977capture request header - X X -
978capture response header - X X -
979clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
980contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
981cookie X - X X
982default-server X - X X
983default_backend X X X -
984description - X X X
985disabled X X X X
986dispatch - - X X
987enabled X X X X
988errorfile X X X X
989errorloc X X X X
990errorloc302 X X X X
991-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
992errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200993force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100994fullconn X - X X
995grace X X X X
996hash-type X - X X
997http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100998http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200999http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001000http-request - X X X
1001id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001002ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001003log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001004maxconn X X X -
1005mode X X X X
1006monitor fail - X X -
1007monitor-net X X X -
1008monitor-uri X X X -
1009option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1010option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1011option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1012option allbackups (*) X - X X
1013option checkcache (*) X - X X
1014option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1015option contstats (*) X X X -
1016option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1017option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1018option forceclose (*) X X X X
1019-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1020option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001021option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001022option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001023option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1024option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1025option httpchk X - X X
1026option httpclose (*) X X X X
1027option httplog X X X X
1028option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1029option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001030option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001031option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1032option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1033option logasap (*) X X X -
1034option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001035option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036option nolinger (*) X X X X
1037option originalto X X X X
1038option persist (*) X - X X
1039option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001040option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option smtpchk X - X X
1042option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1043option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1044option splice-request (*) X X X X
1045option splice-response (*) X X X X
1046option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1047option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1048-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1049option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1050option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1051option tcpka X X X X
1052option tcplog X X X X
1053option transparent (*) X - X X
1054persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1055rate-limit sessions X X X -
1056redirect - X X X
1057redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1058redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1059reqadd - X X X
1060reqallow - X X X
1061reqdel - X X X
1062reqdeny - X X X
1063reqiallow - X X X
1064reqidel - X X X
1065reqideny - X X X
1066reqipass - X X X
1067reqirep - X X X
1068reqisetbe - X X X
1069reqitarpit - X X X
1070reqpass - X X X
1071reqrep - X X X
1072-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1073reqsetbe - X X X
1074reqtarpit - X X X
1075retries X - X X
1076rspadd - X X X
1077rspdel - X X X
1078rspdeny - X X X
1079rspidel - X X X
1080rspideny - X X X
1081rspirep - X X X
1082rsprep - X X X
1083server - - X X
1084source X - X X
1085srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001086stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001087stats auth X - X X
1088stats enable X - X X
1089stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001090stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001091stats realm X - X X
1092stats refresh X - X X
1093stats scope X - X X
1094stats show-desc X - X X
1095stats show-legends X - X X
1096stats show-node X - X X
1097stats uri X - X X
1098-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1099stick match - - X X
1100stick on - - X X
1101stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001102stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001104tcp-request connection - X X -
1105tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001106tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001107tcp-response content - - X X
1108tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109timeout check X - X X
1110timeout client X X X -
1111timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1112timeout connect X - X X
1113timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1114timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1115timeout http-request X X X X
1116timeout queue X - X X
1117timeout server X - X X
1118timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1119timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001120timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001121transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001122unique-id-format X X X -
1123unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001125use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001126------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1127 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011304.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1131---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001132
1133This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1134
1135
1136acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1137 Declare or complete an access list.
1138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1139 no | yes | yes | yes
1140 Example:
1141 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1142 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1143 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001145 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001146
1147
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001148appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1149 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1152 no | no | yes | yes
1153 Arguments :
1154 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1155 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1156
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001157 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158 checked in each cookie value.
1159
1160 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1161 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1162 milliseconds.
1163
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001164 request-learn
1165 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1166 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1167 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1168 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1169 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1170 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1171
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001172 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1173 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1174 data following this prefix.
1175
1176 Example :
1177 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1178
1179 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1180 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1181
1182 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1183 2 modes are currently supported :
1184 - path-parameters :
1185 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1186 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1187 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1188 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1189 - query-string :
1190 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1191 query string.
1192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001193 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1194 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1195 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1196 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001197 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1198 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1199 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001200 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1201 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1202
1203 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1204
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001205 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1206 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1207 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1208
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209 Example :
1210 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1211
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001212 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1213 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001214
1215
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001216backlog <conns>
1217 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1219 yes | yes | yes | no
1220 Arguments :
1221 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1222 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001223 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001224
1225 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1226 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1227 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1228 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1229 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1230 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1231 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1232 backlog parameter.
1233
1234 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1235 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1236 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1237
1238 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1239
1240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001242balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1245 yes | no | yes | yes
1246 Arguments :
1247 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1248 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1249 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1250 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1251
1252 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1253 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1254 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1255 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001256 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1257 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1258 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1259 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1260 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1261 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1262 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1263 it, so that you don't worry.
1264
1265 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1266 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1267 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1268 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1269 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1270 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1271 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1272 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001273
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001274 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1275 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1276 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1277 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1278 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1279 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1280 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1281 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1282
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001283 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1284 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1285 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1286 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001287 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001288 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1289 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1290 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1291 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1292 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001293 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1294 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1295 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1296 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1297 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1298 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001300 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1301 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1302 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1303 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1304 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1305 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1306 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1307 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001308 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001310 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1311 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1312 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001313
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001314 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1315 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1316 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1317 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1318 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1319 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1320 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1321 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1322 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1323 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1324 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1325 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001326
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001327 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001328 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1329 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1330 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1331 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1332 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1333 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1334 URIs start with a leading "/".
1335
1336 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1337 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1338 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1339 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001341 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001342 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1343
1344 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001345 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1346 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1347 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1348 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1349 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1350 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1351 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1352 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1353 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1354 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1355 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1356 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1357 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1358 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1359 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1360 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1361 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1362 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1363 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001364
1365 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1366 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1367 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1368 server will receive the request.
1369
1370 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1371 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1372 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1373 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1374 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001375 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1376 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1377 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001378
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001379 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1380 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1381 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1382 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1383 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001385 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001386 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1387 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1388 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1389
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001390 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1391 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1392 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1393
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001394 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001395 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001396 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1397 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1398 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1399 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1400 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1401 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001402 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001403 used instead.
1404
1405 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1406 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1407 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1408 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1409
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001410 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1411 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1412 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1413
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001414 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001416 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001417 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1418 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001419
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001420 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001421 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001422
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001423 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1424 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1425 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426
1427 Examples :
1428 balance roundrobin
1429 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001430 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001431 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1432 balance hdr(host)
1433 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001434
1435 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1436 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001438 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001439 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1440 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1441 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1442 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1443
1444 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1445 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1446 defaults to 16 kB.
1447
1448 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1449 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1450
1451 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1452 Round Robin.
1453
1454 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1455 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1456 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1457 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1458
1459 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1460
1461 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001462 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001463 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1464 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1465 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001467 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1468 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001469
1470
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001471bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1472bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1473bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1474bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1475bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1476bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1477bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001478bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001479bind /<path> [, ...]
1480bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1481bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1482bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001483 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1485 no | yes | yes | no
1486 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001487 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1488 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1489 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1490 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001491 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001492
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001493 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1494 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001495 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1496 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1497 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001498 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1499 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1500 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1501 the range.
1502
1503 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1504 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1505 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1506 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1507 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1508 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1509 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1510 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1511 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001512
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001513 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1514 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1515 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1516 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1517 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1518 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1519 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1520 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1521
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001522 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1523 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1524 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1525 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1526 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1527 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1528 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1529 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001530 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1531 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001532
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001533 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1534 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1535 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1536 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1537 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1538 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001539 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1540 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1541 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1542 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1543 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1544 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1545 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1546 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001547
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001548 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1549 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1550 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1551 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001552
1553 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1554
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001555 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1556 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1557 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1558 simply ignore this.
1559
1560 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1561 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1562 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1563 simply ignore this.
1564
1565 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1566 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1567 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1568 this.
1569
1570 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1571 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1572 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1573 this.
1574
1575 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1576 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1577 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1578 this.
1579
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001580 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1581 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1582 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001583 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001584 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1585 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1586 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1587 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001588 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1589 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001590
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001591 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001592 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1593 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1594 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1595 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1596 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1597 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1598 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1599 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1600 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1601 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1602 with front firewalls which would see an established
1603 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1604
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001605 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1606 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1607 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1608 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1609 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1610 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1611 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1612 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1613 This keyword combined with support from external components
1614 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1615 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1616 not even always usable.
1617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1619 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1620 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1621 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1622 in a frontend.
1623
1624 Example :
1625 listen http_proxy
1626 bind :80,:443
1627 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001628 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001629
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001630 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001631 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632
1633
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001634bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1635 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1637 yes | yes | yes | yes
1638 Arguments :
1639 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1640 may be used to override a default value.
1641
1642 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1643 option may be combined with other numbers.
1644
1645 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1646 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1647 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1648 missing from all processes.
1649
1650 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1651 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1652 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1653 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1654
1655 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1656 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1657 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1658 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1659 and 'even' instances.
1660
1661 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1662 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1663 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1664 32.
1665
1666 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1667 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1668
1669 Example :
1670 listen app_ip1
1671 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001672 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001673
1674 listen app_ip2
1675 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001676 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001677
1678 listen management
1679 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001680 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001681
1682 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1683
1684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685block { if | unless } <condition>
1686 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1688 no | yes | yes | yes
1689
1690 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1691 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001692 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001693 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1695 "block" statements per instance.
1696
1697 Example:
1698 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1699 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1700 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1701 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001703 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705
1706capture cookie <name> len <length>
1707 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1709 no | yes | yes | no
1710 Arguments :
1711 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1712 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1713 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1714 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1715 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1716
1717 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1718 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1719 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1720 right if it exceeds <length>.
1721
1722 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1723 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1724 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1725 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1726
1727 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1728 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1729 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1730
1731 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1732 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1733 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1734 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001735 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1737
1738 Example:
1739 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1740
1741 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001742 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743
1744
1745capture request header <name> len <length>
1746 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1748 no | yes | yes | no
1749 Arguments :
1750 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001751 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001752 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1753 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1754 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1755
1756 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1757 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1758 it exceeds <length>.
1759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001760 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1762 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001763 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1764 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1765 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1766 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001767 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001768 environments to find where the request came from.
1769
1770 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1771 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1772 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1773 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774
1775 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1776 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1777 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1778 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1779
1780 Example:
1781 capture request header Host len 15
1782 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1783 capture request header Referrer len 15
1784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001785 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786 about logging.
1787
1788
1789capture response header <name> len <length>
1790 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1792 no | yes | yes | no
1793 Arguments :
1794 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001795 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001796 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1797 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1798 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1799
1800 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1801 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1802 it exceeds <length>.
1803
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001804 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001805 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1806 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1807 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001808 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1809 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1810 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1811 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001812
1813 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1814 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1815 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1816 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1817
1818 Example:
1819 capture response header Content-length len 9
1820 capture response header Location len 15
1821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001822 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 about logging.
1824
1825
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001826clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001827 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1829 yes | yes | yes | no
1830 Arguments :
1831 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1833 as explained at the top of this document.
1834
1835 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1836 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1837 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1838 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1839 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1840 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1841 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1842 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001843 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1845 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1846
1847 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1848 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1849 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1850 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1851 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1852 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1853
1854 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1855 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1856
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001857 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1858 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001859
1860
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001861contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001862 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1864 yes | no | yes | yes
1865 Arguments :
1866 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1867 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1868 as explained at the top of this document.
1869
1870 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001871 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001872 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1874 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1875 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1876 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1877
1878 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1879 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1880 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1881 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1882 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1883 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1884
1885 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1886 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1887 instead.
1888
1889 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1890 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1891
1892
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001893cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001894 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1895 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1898 yes | no | yes | yes
1899 Arguments :
1900 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1901 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1902 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1903 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1904 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1905 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1906 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1907 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1908 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1909
1910 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1911 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1912 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1913 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1914 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1915 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1916 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1917 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1918 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1919 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1920 "insert" and "prefix".
1921
1922 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001923 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001924
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001925 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001926 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1927 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1928 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1929 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1930 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1931 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1932 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1933 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1934 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1935 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936
1937 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1938 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1939 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1940 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1941 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1942 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1943 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1944 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1945 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1946 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001947 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1948 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1949 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001951 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1952 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1953 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001954 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1955 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1956 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1957 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001958 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1959 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1960 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001961
1962 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1963 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1964 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1965 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1966 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1967 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1968 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1969 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1970 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1971
1972 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1973 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1974 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1975 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1976 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1977 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1978 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1979 persistence cookie in the cache.
1980 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1981
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001982 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1983 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1984 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1985 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1986 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1987 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1988 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1989 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1990 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1991 they logout.
1992
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001993 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1994 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1995 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1996 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1997
1998 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1999 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2000 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2001 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2002 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2003 this attribute.
2004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002005 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002006 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002007 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2008 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2009 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2010 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2011 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2012 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002013
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002014 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2015 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2016 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2017 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2018 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2019 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2020 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2021 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2022 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2023 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2024 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2025 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2026 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2027 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2028 the site.
2029
2030 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2031 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2032 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2033 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2034 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2035 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2036 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2037 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2038 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2039 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2040 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2041 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2042 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2043 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2044 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2045 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2046
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2048 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2049 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2050 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002051
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 Examples :
2053 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2054 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2055 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002056 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002058 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002059 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002062default-server [param*]
2063 Change default options for a server in a backend
2064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2065 yes | no | yes | yes
2066 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002067 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2068 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2069 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2070 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002071
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002072 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002073 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2074
2075 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002076
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078default_backend <backend>
2079 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2081 yes | yes | yes | no
2082 Arguments :
2083 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2084
2085 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2086 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2087 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2088 will catch all undetermined requests.
2089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 Example :
2091
2092 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2093 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2094 default_backend dynamic
2095
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002096 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2097
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098
2099disabled
2100 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2102 yes | yes | yes | yes
2103 Arguments : none
2104
2105 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2106 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2107 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2108 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2109 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2110 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2111 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2112
2113 See also : "enabled"
2114
2115
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002116dispatch <address>:<port>
2117 Set a default server address
2118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2119 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002120 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002121
2122 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2123 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2124 during start-up.
2125
2126 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2127 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2128 possible with normal servers.
2129
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002130 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002131 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2132 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2133 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2134 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2135
2136 See also : "server"
2137
2138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139enabled
2140 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2142 yes | yes | yes | yes
2143 Arguments : none
2144
2145 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2146 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2147
2148 See also : "disabled"
2149
2150
2151errorfile <code> <file>
2152 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2154 yes | yes | yes | yes
2155 Arguments :
2156 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002157 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158
2159 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002160 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002161 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002162 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2163 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002164
2165 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2166 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2167 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2168
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002169 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2172 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2173 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2174 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2175
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002176 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2177 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2178 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2179 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2180 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2181 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2184 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2185 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002186 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2188
2189 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2190
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002191 Example :
2192 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2193 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2194 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2195
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002196
2197errorloc <code> <url>
2198errorloc302 <code> <url>
2199 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2201 yes | yes | yes | yes
2202 Arguments :
2203 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002204 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002205
2206 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2207 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2208 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2209 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2210 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2211
2212 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2213 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2214 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2215
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002216 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2217
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002218 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2219 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2220 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2221 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2222 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2223 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2224 request.
2225
2226 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2227
2228
2229errorloc303 <code> <url>
2230 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2232 yes | yes | yes | yes
2233 Arguments :
2234 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2235 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2236
2237 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2238 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2239 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2240 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2241 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2242
2243 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2244 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2245 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2246
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002247 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002249 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2250 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2251 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2252 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002253 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002254
2255 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2256
2257
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002258force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2259 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2260 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2261 no | yes | yes | yes
2262
2263 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2264 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2265 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2266 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2267 marked down for maintenance operations.
2268
2269 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2270 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2271 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2272 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2273 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2274 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2275 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2276 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2277 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2278
2279 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2280 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2281 is used.
2282
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002283 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002284 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002285
2286
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002287fullconn <conns>
2288 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2290 yes | no | yes | yes
2291 Arguments :
2292 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2293 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2294
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002295 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002296 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002297 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002298 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2299 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2300 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2301 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2302 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002303 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002304
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002305 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2306 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2307 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2308
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002309 Example :
2310 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2311 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2312 # connections.
2313 backend dynamic
2314 fullconn 10000
2315 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2316 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2317
2318 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2319
2320
2321grace <time>
2322 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002324 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002325 Arguments :
2326 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2327 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2328 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2329
2330 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2331 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002332 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002333 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2334
2335 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2336 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2337 simplify it.
2338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002339
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002340hash-type <method>
2341 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2343 yes | no | yes | yes
2344 Arguments :
2345 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2346 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2347 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2348 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2349 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2350 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2351 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2352 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2353 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2354
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002355 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2356 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2357 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2358 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2359 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2360 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2361 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2362 this value.
2363
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002364 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2365 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2366 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2367 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2368 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2369 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2370 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2371 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2372 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2373 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2374 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2375 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2376 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2377
2378 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2379
2380 See also : "balance", "server"
2381
2382
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383http-check disable-on-404
2384 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002386 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002387 Arguments : none
2388
2389 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2390 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2391 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2392 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2393 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2394 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2395 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2396 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002397 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2398 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2399 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2400
2401 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2402
2403
2404http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2405 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002407 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002408 Arguments :
2409 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2410 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002411 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002412 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2413 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2414 details on the supported keywords.
2415
2416 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2417 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2418 with the usual backslash ('\').
2419
2420 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2421 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2422 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2423 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2424 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2425
2426 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2427 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2428 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2429 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2430 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2431
2432 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2433 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2434 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2435 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2436 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2437 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2438
2439 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2440 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2441 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2442 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2443 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2444 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2445 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2446 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2447 trace).
2448
2449 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2450 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2451 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2452 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2453 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2454 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2455 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2456 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2457
2458 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2459 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2460 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2461 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2462 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2463 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2464 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2465 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2466
2467 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2468 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2469
2470 Examples :
2471 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002472 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002473
2474 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002475 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002476
2477 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002478 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002479
2480 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002481 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002483 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484
2485
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002486http-check send-state
2487 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 yes | no | yes | yes
2490 Arguments : none
2491
2492 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2493 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2494 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2495 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2496 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2497
2498 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2499 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2500 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2501 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2502 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2503 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2504 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2505 checked in multiple backends.
2506
2507 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2508 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2509
2510 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2511 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2512 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2513 one fails.
2514
2515 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2516 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2517 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2518
2519 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2520 server's queue.
2521
2522 Example of a header received by the application server :
2523 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2524 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2525
2526 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2527
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002528http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002529 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002530 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2531
2532 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2533 no | yes | yes | yes
2534
2535 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2536 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2537 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002538 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2539 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002540 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2541
2542 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2543 instance.
2544
2545 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002546 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2547 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2548 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002549
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002550 http-request allow if nagios
2551 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2552 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2553 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002554
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002555 Example:
2556 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002557
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002558 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002559
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002560 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2561 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002562
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002563http-send-name-header [<header>]
2564 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2565
2566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2567 yes | no | yes | yes
2568
2569 Arguments :
2570
2571 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2572
2573 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2574 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2575 is added with the header string proved.
2576
2577 See also : "server"
2578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002579id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002580 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 no | yes | yes | yes
2583 Arguments : none
2584
2585 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2586 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2587 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002588
2589
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002590ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2591 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2593 no | yes | yes | yes
2594
2595 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2596 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2597 and running).
2598
2599 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2600 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2601 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2602 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2603 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2604
2605 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2606 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2607
2608 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2609 "unless" condition is met.
2610
2611 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2612
2613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002614log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002615log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002616no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002617 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2619 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002620
2621 Prefix :
2622 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2623 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2624 prefix does not allow arguments.
2625
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002626 Arguments :
2627 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2628 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2629 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2630 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2631 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2632 parameter.
2633
2634 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2635 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2636
2637 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2638 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2639 standard syslog port).
2640
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002641 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2642 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2643 standard syslog port).
2644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002645 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2646 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2647 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2648 appropriately writeable).
2649
2650 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2651
2652 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2653 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2654 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2655
2656 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2657 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2658 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002659 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2660 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2661 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2662 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2663 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002664
2665 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2666
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002667 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2668 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2669 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002670
2671 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2672 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2673 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2674 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2675
2676 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2677 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678
2679 Example :
2680 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002681 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2682 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002683
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002684log-format <string>
2685 Allows you to custom a log line.
2686
2687 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2688
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002689
2690maxconn <conns>
2691 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2693 yes | yes | yes | no
2694 Arguments :
2695 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2696 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2697 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2698 closes.
2699
2700 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2701 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2702 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2703 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2704 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2705 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2706 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2707 properly tuned.
2708
2709 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2710 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2711 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2712
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002713 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2714
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002715 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2716
2717
2718mode { tcp|http|health }
2719 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2721 yes | yes | yes | yes
2722 Arguments :
2723 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2724 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2725 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2726 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2727
2728 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2729 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2730 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2731 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2732 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2733
2734 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2735 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2736 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2737 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2738 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2739 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2740
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002741 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2742 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2743 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002744
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002745 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002746 defaults http_instances
2747 mode http
2748
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002749 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002752monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002753 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2755 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756 Arguments :
2757 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2758 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002759 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002760 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2761 backend and its backup.
2762
2763 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2764 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2765 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2766 servers in a list of backends.
2767
2768 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2769 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2770 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2771 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2772 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2773 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2774 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002775 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2776 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002777
2778 Example:
2779 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002780 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002781 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2782 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2783 monitor-uri /site_alive
2784 monitor fail if site_dead
2785
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002786 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002787
2788
2789monitor-net <source>
2790 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2792 yes | yes | yes | no
2793 Arguments :
2794 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2795 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2796 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2797 followed by a mask.
2798
2799 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2800 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002801 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002802 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2803
2804 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2805 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2806 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2807 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2808 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2809
2810 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2811 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2812 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2813 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2814 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2815
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002816 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2817 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002818
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002819 Example :
2820 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2821 frontend www
2822 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2823
2824 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2825
2826
2827monitor-uri <uri>
2828 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2830 yes | yes | yes | no
2831 Arguments :
2832 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2833 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2834
2835 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2836 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2837 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2838 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2839 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2840 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2841 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2842 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2843
2844 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2845 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2846 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2847 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2848 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2849 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2850
2851 Example :
2852 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2853 frontend www
2854 mode http
2855 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2856
2857 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002860option abortonclose
2861no option abortonclose
2862 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2864 yes | no | yes | yes
2865 Arguments : none
2866
2867 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2868 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2869 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2870 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002871 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002872 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2873 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2874 encountered while delivering the response.
2875
2876 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2877 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2878 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2879 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2880 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2881 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002882 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002883 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002884 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002885 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2886 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2887 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2888
2889 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2890 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2891 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2892 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2893 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2894 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2895 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2896 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002897 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002898
2899 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2900 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2901
2902 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2903
2904
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002905option accept-invalid-http-request
2906no option accept-invalid-http-request
2907 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2909 yes | yes | yes | no
2910 Arguments : none
2911
2912 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2913 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2914 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2915 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2916 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2917 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2918 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2919 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002920 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2921 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2922 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2923 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2924 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2925 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002926
2927 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2928 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2929 been confirmed.
2930
2931 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2932 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002933 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2934 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002935 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2936
2937 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2938 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2939
2940 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2941 stats socket.
2942
2943
2944option accept-invalid-http-response
2945no option accept-invalid-http-response
2946 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2948 yes | no | yes | yes
2949 Arguments : none
2950
2951 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2952 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2953 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2954 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2955 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2956 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2957 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2958 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2959 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2960
2961 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2962 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2963 been confirmed.
2964
2965 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2966 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2967 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2968 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2969
2970 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2971 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2972
2973 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2974 stats socket.
2975
2976
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002977option allbackups
2978no option allbackups
2979 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2981 yes | no | yes | yes
2982 Arguments : none
2983
2984 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2985 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2986 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2987 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2988 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2989 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2990 order between the backup servers anymore.
2991
2992 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2993 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2994
2995 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2996 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2997
2998
2999option checkcache
3000no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003001 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3003 yes | no | yes | yes
3004 Arguments : none
3005
3006 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3007 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003008 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003009 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3010 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003011 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003012
3013 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003014 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003015 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003016 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3017 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003018 to the client are :
3019 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003020 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003021 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003022 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3023 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3024 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3025 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3026 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3027 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3028 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3029 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3030 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3031 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3032 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3033
3034 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003035 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003036 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003037 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003038 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3039
3040 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3041 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003042 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003043 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3044
3045 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3046 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3047
3048
3049option clitcpka
3050no option clitcpka
3051 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3053 yes | yes | yes | no
3054 Arguments : none
3055
3056 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3057 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3058 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3059 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3060
3061 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3062 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3063 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3064 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3065
3066 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3067 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3068 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3069 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3070 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3071
3072 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3073
3074 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3075 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3076 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3077
3078 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3079 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3080
3081 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3082
3083
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084option contstats
3085 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3087 yes | yes | yes | no
3088 Arguments : none
3089
3090 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3091 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3092 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3093 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3094 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3095 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3096 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3097
3098
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003099option dontlog-normal
3100no option dontlog-normal
3101 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3103 yes | yes | yes | no
3104 Arguments : none
3105
3106 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3107 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3108 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3109 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3110 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3111 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3112 logged.
3113
3114 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3115 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3116 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003118 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003119 logging.
3120
3121
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003122option dontlognull
3123no option dontlognull
3124 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3126 yes | yes | yes | no
3127 Arguments : none
3128
3129 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3130 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3131 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3132 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3133 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3134 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3135 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3136
3137 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3138 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3139 would not be logged.
3140
3141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003144 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003145
3146
3147option forceclose
3148no option forceclose
3149 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003151 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003152 Arguments : none
3153
3154 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3155 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3156 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3157 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3158 global session times in the logs.
3159
3160 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003161 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003162 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3163 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3164 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3165 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003166
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003167 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3168 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3169 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3170
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003171 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3172 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3173
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003174 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003175
3176
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003177option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003178 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3180 yes | yes | yes | yes
3181 Arguments :
3182 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3183 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003184 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003185 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003186
3187 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3188 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3189 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3190 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3191 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3192 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3193 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003194 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3195 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3196 possible that the client has already brought one.
3197
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003198 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003199 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003200 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3201 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003202 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3203 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003204
3205 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3206 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3207 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3208 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3209 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3210 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3211 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3212
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003213 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3214 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3215 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3216 are under the control of the end-user.
3217
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003218 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003219 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3220 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003221 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3222 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3223 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003224
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003225 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3226 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3227 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3228 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3229 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003230
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003231 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003232 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3233 frontend www
3234 mode http
3235 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3236
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003237 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3238 backend www
3239 mode http
3240 option forwardfor header X-Client
3241
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003242 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3243 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003244
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003245
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003246option http-no-delay
3247no option http-no-delay
3248 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3250 yes | yes | yes | yes
3251 Arguments : none
3252
3253 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3254 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3255 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3256 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3257 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3258 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3259 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3260 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3261 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3262 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3263 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3264 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3265 affected.
3266
3267 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3268 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3269 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3270 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3271 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3272 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3273 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3274 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3275 latency environments.
3276
3277
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003278option http-pretend-keepalive
3279no option http-pretend-keepalive
3280 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3282 yes | yes | yes | yes
3283 Arguments : none
3284
3285 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3286 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3287 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3288 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3289 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3290 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3291 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3292 consider the response complete.
3293
3294 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3295 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3296 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3297 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3298 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3299 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3300
3301 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3302 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3303 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3304 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3305 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3306 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3307 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3308
3309 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3310 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003311 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3312 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3313 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003314
3315 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3316 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3317
3318 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3319
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003320
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003321option http-server-close
3322no option http-server-close
3323 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3325 yes | yes | yes | yes
3326 Arguments : none
3327
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003328 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3329 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3330 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3331 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3332 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3333 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3334 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3335 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3336 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3337 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3338 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3339 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003340
3341 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3342 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3343 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3344 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003345 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3346 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003347
3348 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3349 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003350 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3351 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3352 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003353
3354 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3355 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3356
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003357 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3358 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003359
3360
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003361option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003362no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003363 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3365 yes | yes | yes | no
3366 Arguments : none
3367
3368 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3369 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3370 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3371 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3372 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3373 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3374 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3375
3376 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3377 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3378 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3379 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3380 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3381 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3382 request along its whole life.
3383
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003384 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3385 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3386 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3387 front of an existing proxy.
3388
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003389 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3390
3391 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3392 http-server-close".
3393
3394
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003395option httpchk
3396option httpchk <uri>
3397option httpchk <method> <uri>
3398option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3399 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 yes | no | yes | yes
3402 Arguments :
3403 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3404 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3405 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3406 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3407 ones.
3408
3409 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3410 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3411 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3412
3413 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3414 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3415 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3416 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3417 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3418
3419 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3420 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3421 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3422 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3423 the lack of any response.
3424
3425 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3426
3427 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3428 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3429 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3430
3431 Examples :
3432 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3433 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3434 backend https_relay
3435 mode tcp
3436 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3437 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3438
3439 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003440 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3441 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003442
3443
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003444option httpclose
3445no option httpclose
3446 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3448 yes | yes | yes | yes
3449 Arguments : none
3450
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003451 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3452 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3453 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3454 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3455 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3456 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3457 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003458
3459 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003460 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3461 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3462 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3463 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3464 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3465 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003466
3467 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3468 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3469 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003470 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3471 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003472
3473 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3474 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3475
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003476 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3477 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003478
3479
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003480option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003481 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003484 Arguments :
3485 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3486 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3487 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3488 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3489 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003490
3491 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3492 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3493 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3494 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3495 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3496 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3497 ports.
3498
3499 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3500
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003501 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3502 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3503 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3504 by default.
3505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003506 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003507
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003508
3509option http_proxy
3510no option http_proxy
3511 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3513 yes | yes | yes | yes
3514 Arguments : none
3515
3516 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3517 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3518 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3519 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3520 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3521
3522 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3523 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3524 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3525 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003526 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003527 be analyzed.
3528
3529 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3530 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3531
3532 Example :
3533 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3534 backend direct_forward
3535 option httpclose
3536 option http_proxy
3537
3538 See also : "option httpclose"
3539
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003540
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003541option independant-streams
3542no option independant-streams
3543 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3545 yes | yes | yes | yes
3546 Arguments : none
3547
3548 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3549 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3550 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3551 receive data or not.
3552
3553 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3554 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3555 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3556 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3557 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3558 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3559 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3560 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3561 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3562 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3563 socket buffers.
3564
3565 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3566 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3567 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3568 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3569 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3570
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003571 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003572
3573
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003574option ldap-check
3575 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3577 yes | no | yes | yes
3578 Arguments : none
3579
3580 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3581 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3582 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3583 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3584
3585 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3586 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3587
3588 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3589 configure it.
3590
3591 Example :
3592 option ldap-check
3593
3594 See also : "option httpchk"
3595
3596
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003597option log-health-checks
3598no option log-health-checks
3599 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | no | yes | yes
3602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3605 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3606 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3607 of additional information is limited.
3608
3609 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3610 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3611
3612 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3613
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003614
3615option log-separate-errors
3616no option log-separate-errors
3617 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3619 yes | yes | yes | no
3620 Arguments : none
3621
3622 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3623 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3624 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3625 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3626 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3627 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3628 provides very important information.
3629
3630 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3631 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3632 error logs.
3633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003634 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003635 logging.
3636
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003637
3638option logasap
3639no option logasap
3640 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3642 yes | yes | yes | no
3643 Arguments : none
3644
3645 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3646 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3647 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3648 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3649 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3650 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3651 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003652 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003653 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3654 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3655
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003656 Examples :
3657 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3658 mode http
3659 option httplog
3660 option logasap
3661 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3662
3663 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3664 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3665 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3666 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003668 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003669 logging.
3670
3671
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003672option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3673 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3675 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003676 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003677 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3678 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003679
3680 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3681 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3682 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3683 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3684 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3685 in the MySQL table, like this :
3686
3687 USE mysql;
3688 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3689 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3690
3691 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3692 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3693 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3694 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3695 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3696 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3697 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3698 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3699 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3700
3701 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3702 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003703
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003704 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003705
3706 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3707 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3708 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3709 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3710 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3711 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3712
3713 See also: "option httpchk"
3714
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003715option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3716 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3718 yes | no | yes | yes
3719 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003720 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3721 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003722
3723 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3724 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3725 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3726 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3727
3728 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003729
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003730option nolinger
3731no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003732 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3734 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003735 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003736
3737 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3738 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3739 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3740 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3741 connections.
3742
3743 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3744 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3745 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3746 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3747 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3748 this too.
3749
3750 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3751 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3752 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3753
3754 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3755 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3756 for servers.
3757
3758 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3759 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3760
3761
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003762option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3763 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | yes | yes | yes
3766 Arguments :
3767 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3768 matching <network>
3769 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3770 header name.
3771
3772 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3773 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3774 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3775 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3776 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3777 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3778 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3779 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3780 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3781 possible that the client has already brought one.
3782
3783 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3784 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3785 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3786 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3787 header and requires different one.
3788
3789 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3790 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3791 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3792 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3793 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3794 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3795 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3796
3797 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3798 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3799 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3800 both are defined.
3801
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003802 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3803 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3804 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3805 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3806 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003807
3808 Examples :
3809 # Original Destination address
3810 frontend www
3811 mode http
3812 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3813
3814 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3815 backend www
3816 mode http
3817 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3818
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003819 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3820 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003821
3822
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003823option persist
3824no option persist
3825 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003828 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003829
3830 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3831 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3832 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3833 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3834 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3835 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3836 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3837 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3838 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3839 redirected to another valid server.
3840
3841 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3842 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3843
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003844 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003845
3846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003847option redispatch
3848no option redispatch
3849 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003852 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003853
3854 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3855 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3856 be able to access the service anymore.
3857
3858 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3859 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3860
3861 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3862 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3863 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003864
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003865 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3866 "redisp" keywords.
3867
3868 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3869 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3870
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003871 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003872
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003873
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003874option redis-check
3875 Use redis health checks for server testing
3876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3877 yes | no | yes | yes
3878 Arguments : none
3879
3880 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3881 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3882 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3883 find the "+PONG" response message.
3884
3885 Example :
3886 option redis-check
3887
3888 See also : "option httpchk"
3889
3890
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003891option smtpchk
3892option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3893 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3895 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003896 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003897 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3898 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3899 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3900
3901 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3902 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3903 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3904
3905 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3906 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3907 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3908 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3909 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3910 dead server.
3911
3912 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3913 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3914 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3915 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3916
3917 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3918 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3919 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3920 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3921 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3922
3923 Example :
3924 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3925
3926 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003929option socket-stats
3930no option socket-stats
3931
3932 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | no
3935
3936 Arguments : none
3937
3938
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003939option splice-auto
3940no option splice-auto
3941 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3943 yes | yes | yes | yes
3944 Arguments : none
3945
3946 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3947 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3948 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3949 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003950 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003951 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3952 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3953 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3954 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3955
3956 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3957 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3958 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3959 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3960 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3961 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3962 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3963 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3964 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3965 keyword.
3966
3967 Example :
3968 option splice-auto
3969
3970 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3971 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3972
3973 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3974 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3975
3976
3977option splice-request
3978no option splice-request
3979 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3981 yes | yes | yes | yes
3982 Arguments : none
3983
3984 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3985 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3986 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3987 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3988 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3989 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3990
3991 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3992
3993 Example :
3994 option splice-request
3995
3996 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3997 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3998
3999 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4000 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4001
4002
4003option splice-response
4004no option splice-response
4005 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 yes | yes | yes | yes
4008 Arguments : none
4009
4010 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4011 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
4012 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4013 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4014 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4015 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4016
4017 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4018
4019 Example :
4020 option splice-response
4021
4022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4024
4025 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4026 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4027
4028
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004029option srvtcpka
4030no option srvtcpka
4031 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 yes | no | yes | yes
4034 Arguments : none
4035
4036 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4037 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4038 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4039 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4040
4041 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4042 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4043 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4044 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4045
4046 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4047 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4048 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4049 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4050 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4051
4052 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4053
4054 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4055 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4056 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4057
4058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4060
4061 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4062
4063
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004064option ssl-hello-chk
4065 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4067 yes | no | yes | yes
4068 Arguments : none
4069
4070 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4071 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4072 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4073 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4074 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4075 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4076 hello message.
4077
4078 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4079 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4080 messages, which is appreciable.
4081
4082 See also: "option httpchk"
4083
4084
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004085option tcp-smart-accept
4086no option tcp-smart-accept
4087 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4089 yes | yes | yes | no
4090 Arguments : none
4091
4092 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4093 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4094 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4095 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4096 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4097 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4098
4099 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4100 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4101 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4102 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4103
4104 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4105 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4106 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4107 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4108
4109 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4110 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4111 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4112
4113 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4114 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4115 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4116
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004117 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4118
4119
4120option tcp-smart-connect
4121no option tcp-smart-connect
4122 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 yes | no | yes | yes
4125 Arguments : none
4126
4127 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4128 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4129 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4130 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4131 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4132
4133 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4134 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4135 complex.
4136
4137 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4138 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4139 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4140
4141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4143
4144 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4145
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004146
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004147option tcpka
4148 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4150 yes | yes | yes | yes
4151 Arguments : none
4152
4153 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4154 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4155 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4156 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4157
4158 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4159 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4160 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4161 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4162
4163 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4164 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4165 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4166 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4167 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4168
4169 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4170
4171 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4172 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4173 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4174 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4175 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4176 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4177 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4178 backends.
4179
4180 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4181
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004182
4183option tcplog
4184 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4186 yes | yes | yes | yes
4187 Arguments : none
4188
4189 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4190 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4191 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4192 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4193 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4194 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4195 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4196 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4197
4198 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004200 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004201
4202
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004203option transparent
4204no option transparent
4205 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004207 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004208 Arguments : none
4209
4210 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4211 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4212 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4213 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4214 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4215 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4216 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4217 appropriate server.
4218
4219 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4220 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4221
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004222 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004223 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004224
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004225
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004226persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004227persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004228 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4230 yes | no | yes | yes
4231 Arguments :
4232 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004233 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4234 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004235
4236 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4237 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4238 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4239 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4240 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4241 forwarded to this server.
4242
4243 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4244 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4245 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004246 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004247 a single "listen" section.
4248
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004249 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4250 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4251 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4252
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004253 Example :
4254 listen tse-farm
4255 bind :3389
4256 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4257 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4258 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4259 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4260 persist rdp-cookie
4261 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004262 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004263 balance rdp-cookie
4264 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4265 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4266
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004267 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4268 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004269
4270
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004271rate-limit sessions <rate>
4272 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4274 yes | yes | yes | no
4275 Arguments :
4276 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4277 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4278
4279 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4280 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4281 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4282 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4283 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4284 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4285
4286 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4287 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4288 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4289 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4290
4291 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4292 listen smtp
4293 mode tcp
4294 bind :25
4295 rate-limit sessions 10
4296 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4297
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004298 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4299 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4300 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004301
4302 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4303
4304
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004305redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4306redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004307 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4309 no | yes | yes | yes
4310
4311 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004312 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004313
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004314 Arguments :
4315 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4316 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4317 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4318 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004319 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4320 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4321 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4322 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004323
4324 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4325 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4326 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4327 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4328 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4329 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4330 location with a GET method.
4331
4332 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4333 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4334
4335 - "drop-query"
4336 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4337 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4338 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4339 with a location-type redirect.
4340
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004341 - "append-slash"
4342 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4343 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4344 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4345 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4346
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004347 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4348 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4349 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4350 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4351 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4352 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4353 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4354
4355 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4356 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4357 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4358 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4359 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4360 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4361 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004362
4363 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4364 acl clear dst_port 80
4365 acl secure dst_port 8080
4366 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004367 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004368 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004369 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4370
4371 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004372 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4373 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4374 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004375 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004376
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004377 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4378 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4379 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004381 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004382
4383
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004384redisp (deprecated)
4385redispatch (deprecated)
4386 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4387 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4388 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004389 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004390
4391 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4392 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4393 be able to access the service anymore.
4394
4395 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4396 redistribute them to a working server.
4397
4398 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4399 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4400 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004402 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4403 "option redispatch" instead.
4404
4405 See also : "option redispatch"
4406
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004407
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004408reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004409 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 no | yes | yes | yes
4412 Arguments :
4413 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4414 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004415 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004416
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004417 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4418 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4419
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004420 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4421 the last header of an HTTP request.
4422
4423 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4424 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4425 responses.
4426
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004427 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4428 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4429 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4430
4431 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4432 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004433
4434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004435reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4436reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004437 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4439 no | yes | yes | yes
4440 Arguments :
4441 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4442 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4443 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4444 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4445 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4446 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4447 ignores case.
4448
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004449 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4450 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4451
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004452 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4453 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4454 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4455 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004456 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004457
4458 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4459 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4460
4461 Example :
4462 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4463 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4464 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4465
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004466 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4467 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004468
4469
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004470reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4471reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004472 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4474 no | yes | yes | yes
4475 Arguments :
4476 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4477 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4478 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4479 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4480 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4481 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4482
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004483 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4484 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4485
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004486 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4487 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4488 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4489 next servers.
4490
4491 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4492 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4493 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4494
4495 Example :
4496 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4497 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4498 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4499
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004500 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4501 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004502
4503
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004504reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4505reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004506 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 no | yes | yes | yes
4509 Arguments :
4510 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4511 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4512 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4513 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4514 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4515 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4516 case.
4517
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004518 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4519 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4520
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004521 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4522 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4523 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4524 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004525 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004526
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004527 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004528 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004529 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004530
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004531 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4532 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4533
4534 Example :
4535 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4536 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4537 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4538
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004539 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4540 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004541
4542
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004543reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4544reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004545 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4547 no | yes | yes | yes
4548 Arguments :
4549 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4550 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4551 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4552 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4553 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4554 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4555 case.
4556
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004557 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4558 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4559
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004560 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4561 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4562 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4563 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4564
4565 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4566 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4567
4568 Example :
4569 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4570 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4571 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4572 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4573
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004574 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4575 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004576
4577
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004578reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4579reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004580 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4582 no | yes | yes | yes
4583 Arguments :
4584 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4585 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4586 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4587 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4588 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4589 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4590
4591 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4592 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4593 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4594 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004595 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004596
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004597 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4598 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4599
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004600 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4601 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4602 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4603
4604 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4605 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4606 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4607 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4608 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4609
4610 Example :
4611 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004612 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004613 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4614 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4615
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004616 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4617 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004618
4619
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004620reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4621reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004622 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 no | yes | yes | yes
4625 Arguments :
4626 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4627 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4628 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4629 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4630 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4631 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4632 ignores case.
4633
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004634 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4635 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4636
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004637 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4638 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004639 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4640 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4641 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004642 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4643 not set.
4644
4645 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4646 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4647 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4648 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4649 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4650
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004651 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004652 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4653 # block all others.
4654 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4655 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4656
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004657 # block bad guys
4658 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4659 reqitarpit . if badguys
4660
4661 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4662 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004663
4664
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004665retries <value>
4666 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4668 yes | no | yes | yes
4669 Arguments :
4670 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4671 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4672 default value is 3.
4673
4674 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4675 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4676 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4677
4678 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4679 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4680
4681 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4682 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4683
4684 See also : "option redispatch"
4685
4686
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004687rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004688 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4690 no | yes | yes | yes
4691 Arguments :
4692 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4693 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004694 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004695
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004696 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4697 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4698
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004699 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4700 the last header of an HTTP response.
4701
4702 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4703 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4704 responses.
4705
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004706 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4707 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004708
4709
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004710rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4711rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004712 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 no | yes | yes | yes
4715 Arguments :
4716 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4717 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4718 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4719 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4720 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4721 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4722 ignores case.
4723
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004724 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4725 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4726
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004727 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4728 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004729 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004730 client.
4731
4732 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4733 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4734 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4735
4736 Example :
4737 # remove the Server header from responses
4738 reqidel ^Server:.*
4739
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004740 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4741 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004742
4743
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004744rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4745rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004746 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4748 no | yes | yes | yes
4749 Arguments :
4750 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4751 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4752 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4753 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4754 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4755 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4756 ignores case.
4757
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004758 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4759 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4760
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004761 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4762 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4763 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4764 case-sensitive.
4765
4766 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004767 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4768 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4769 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004770
4771 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4772 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4773
4774 Example :
4775 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4776 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4777
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004778 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4779 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004780
4781
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004782rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4783rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004784 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 no | yes | yes | yes
4787 Arguments :
4788 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4789 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4790 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4791 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4792 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4793 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4794 ignores case.
4795
4796 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4797 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4798 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4799 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004800 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004801
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004802 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4803 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4804
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004805 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4806 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4807 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4808
4809 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4810 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4811 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4812 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4813 are not case-sensitive.
4814
4815 Example :
4816 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4817 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4818
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004819 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4820 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004821
4822
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004823server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004824 Declare a server in a backend
4825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 no | no | yes | yes
4827 Arguments :
4828 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004829 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4830 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004831
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004832 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4833 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4834 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4835 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004836 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4837 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4838 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4839 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4840 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4841 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004842
4843 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4844 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4845 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4846 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4847 adding this value to the client's port.
4848
4849 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4850 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004851 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004852
4853 Examples :
4854 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4855 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4856
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004857 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4858 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004859
4860
4861source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004862source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004863source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004864 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | no | yes | yes
4867 Arguments :
4868 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4869 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4870 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4871 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4872
4873 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4874 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004875 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4876 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4877 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004878
4879 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4880 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4881 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4882 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4883 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4884 <addr>.
4885
4886 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4887 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4888 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4889 port.
4890
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004891 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4892 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4893 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4894 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4895 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4896 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4897 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4898 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4899 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4900 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4901 HTTP header.
4902
4903 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4904 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4905 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4906 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4907 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4908 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4909 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4910 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4911 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4912 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4913
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004914 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4915 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4916 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4917 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4918 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4919 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4920
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004921 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4922 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4923 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4924 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4925
4926 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4927 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4928 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4929 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4930 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4931 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4932
4933 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4934 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4935 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4936 there are two methods :
4937
4938 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4939 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4940 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4941 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4942 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4943 of the client ranges may be used.
4944
4945 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4946 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4947 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4948 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4949 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4950 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4951 same session.
4952
4953 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4954 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4955 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4956 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4957 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4958 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4959
4960 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4961 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4962 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004963 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004964
4965 Examples :
4966 backend private
4967 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4968 source 192.168.1.200
4969
4970 backend transparent_ssl1
4971 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4972 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4973
4974 backend transparent_ssl2
4975 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4976 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4977 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4978
4979 backend transparent_ssl3
4980 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4981 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4982 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4983
4984 backend transparent_smtp
4985 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4986 # with Tproxy version 4.
4987 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4988
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004989 backend transparent_http
4990 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4991 # proxy.
4992 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004994 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004995 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4996
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004997
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004998srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4999 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 yes | no | yes | yes
5002 Arguments :
5003 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5005 as explained at the top of this document.
5006
5007 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5008 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5009 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5010 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5011 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5012 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5013 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5014
5015 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5016 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5017 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5018 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5019 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005020 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005021 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005022 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005023
5024 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5025 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5026 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5027 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5028 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5029 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5030
5031 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5032 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5033
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005034 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5035 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005036
5037
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005038stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5039 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5041 no | no | yes | yes
5042
5043 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5044 matched.
5045
5046 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5047 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5048
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005049 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5050 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5051 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5052
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005053 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5054 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5055 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5056 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005057
5058 Example :
5059 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5060 backend stats_localhost
5061 stats enable
5062 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5063
5064 Example :
5065 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5066 backend stats_auth
5067 stats enable
5068 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5069 stats admin if TRUE
5070
5071 Example :
5072 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5073 userlist stats-auth
5074 group admin users admin
5075 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5076 group readonly users haproxy
5077 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5078
5079 backend stats_auth
5080 stats enable
5081 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5082 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5083 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5084 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5085
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005086 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5087 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5088 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005089
5090
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005091stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5092 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5094 yes | no | yes | yes
5095 Arguments :
5096 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5097
5098 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5099
5100 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5101 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5102 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5103 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5104 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5105 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5106
5107 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5108 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5109 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005110 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005111
5112 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5113 report using "stats scope".
5114
5115 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5116 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5117 unobvious parameters.
5118
5119 Example :
5120 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5121 backend public_www
5122 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5123 stats enable
5124 stats hide-version
5125 stats scope .
5126 stats uri /admin?stats
5127 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5128 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5129 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5130
5131 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5132 backend private_monitoring
5133 stats enable
5134 stats uri /admin?stats
5135 stats refresh 5s
5136
5137 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5138
5139
5140stats enable
5141 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5143 yes | no | yes | yes
5144 Arguments : none
5145
5146 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5147 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5148 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5149 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5150 - stats auth : no authentication
5151 - stats scope : no restriction
5152
5153 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5154 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5155 unobvious parameters.
5156
5157 Example :
5158 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5159 backend public_www
5160 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5161 stats enable
5162 stats hide-version
5163 stats scope .
5164 stats uri /admin?stats
5165 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5166 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5167 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5168
5169 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5170 backend private_monitoring
5171 stats enable
5172 stats uri /admin?stats
5173 stats refresh 5s
5174
5175 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5176
5177
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005178stats hide-version
5179 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5181 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005182 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005183
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005184 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5185 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5186 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5187 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5188 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5189 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005190
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005191 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5192 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5193 unobvious parameters.
5194
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005195 Example :
5196 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5197 backend public_www
5198 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005199 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005200 stats hide-version
5201 stats scope .
5202 stats uri /admin?stats
5203 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5204 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5205 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005206
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005207 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5208 backend private_monitoring
5209 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005210 stats uri /admin?stats
5211 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005212
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005213 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005214
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005215
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005216stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5217 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5218 Access control for statistics
5219
5220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5221 no | no | yes | yes
5222
5223 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5224 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5225 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5226 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5227 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5228 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5229
5230 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5231 instance.
5232
5233 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5234 about ACL usage.
5235
5236
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005237stats realm <realm>
5238 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5240 yes | no | yes | yes
5241 Arguments :
5242 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5243 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5244 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5245
5246 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5247 using a backslash ('\').
5248
5249 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5250 only related to authentication.
5251
5252 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5253 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5254 unobvious parameters.
5255
5256 Example :
5257 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5258 backend public_www
5259 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5260 stats enable
5261 stats hide-version
5262 stats scope .
5263 stats uri /admin?stats
5264 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5265 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5266 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5267
5268 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5269 backend private_monitoring
5270 stats enable
5271 stats uri /admin?stats
5272 stats refresh 5s
5273
5274 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5275
5276
5277stats refresh <delay>
5278 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5280 yes | no | yes | yes
5281 Arguments :
5282 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5283 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5284 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5285 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5286 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5287 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5288
5289 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5290 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5291 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5292 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5293
5294 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5295 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5296 unobvious parameters.
5297
5298 Example :
5299 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5300 backend public_www
5301 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5302 stats enable
5303 stats hide-version
5304 stats scope .
5305 stats uri /admin?stats
5306 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5307 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5308 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5309
5310 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5311 backend private_monitoring
5312 stats enable
5313 stats uri /admin?stats
5314 stats refresh 5s
5315
5316 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5317
5318
5319stats scope { <name> | "." }
5320 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 yes | no | yes | yes
5323 Arguments :
5324 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5325 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5326 section in which the statement appears.
5327
5328 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5329 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5330 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5331 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5332 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5333 exists.
5334
5335 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5336 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5337 unobvious parameters.
5338
5339 Example :
5340 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5341 backend public_www
5342 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5343 stats enable
5344 stats hide-version
5345 stats scope .
5346 stats uri /admin?stats
5347 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5348 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5349 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5350
5351 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5352 backend private_monitoring
5353 stats enable
5354 stats uri /admin?stats
5355 stats refresh 5s
5356
5357 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5358
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005359
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005360stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005361 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5363 yes | no | yes | yes
5364
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005365 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005366 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5367
5368 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5369 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5370
5371 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5372 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005373 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005374
5375 Example :
5376 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5377 backend private_monitoring
5378 stats enable
5379 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5380 stats uri /admin?stats
5381 stats refresh 5s
5382
5383 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5384 global section.
5385
5386
5387stats show-legends
5388 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5389 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5390 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5391 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5392 - IP (socket, server)
5393 - cookie (backend, server)
5394
5395 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5396 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005397 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005398
5399 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5400
5401
5402stats show-node [ <name> ]
5403 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5405 yes | no | yes | yes
5406 Arguments:
5407 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5408 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5409
5410 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5411 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005412 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005413
5414 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5415 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5416 unobvious parameters.
5417
5418 Example:
5419 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5420 backend private_monitoring
5421 stats enable
5422 stats show-node Europe-1
5423 stats uri /admin?stats
5424 stats refresh 5s
5425
5426 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5427 section.
5428
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005429
5430stats uri <prefix>
5431 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5433 yes | no | yes | yes
5434 Arguments :
5435 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5436 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5437 query string.
5438
5439 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5440 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5441 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5442 possible to reach it in the application.
5443
5444 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005445 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005446 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5447 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5448 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5449 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5450
5451 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5452 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5453 an address or a port to statistics only.
5454
5455 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5456 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5457 unobvious parameters.
5458
5459 Example :
5460 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5461 backend public_www
5462 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5463 stats enable
5464 stats hide-version
5465 stats scope .
5466 stats uri /admin?stats
5467 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5468 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5469 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5470
5471 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5472 backend private_monitoring
5473 stats enable
5474 stats uri /admin?stats
5475 stats refresh 5s
5476
5477 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5478
5479
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005480stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5481 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005483 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005484
5485 Arguments :
5486 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5487 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5488 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5489 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5490
5491 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5492 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5493 the "stick-table" statement.
5494
5495 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5496 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5497 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5498 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5499 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5500
5501 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5502 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5503 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5504 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5505 transformation rules.
5506
5507 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5508 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5509 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5510 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5511 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5512 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5513 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5514
5515 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5516 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5517 ACL based conditions.
5518
5519 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5520 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5521 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5522 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5523
5524 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5525 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5526 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5527 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5528
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005529 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5530 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5531 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5532
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005533 Example :
5534 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5535 # last 30 minutes
5536 backend pop
5537 mode tcp
5538 balance roundrobin
5539 stick store-request src
5540 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5541 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5542 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5543
5544 backend smtp
5545 mode tcp
5546 balance roundrobin
5547 stick match src table pop
5548 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5549 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5550
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005551 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5552 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005553
5554
5555stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5556 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5558 no | no | yes | yes
5559
5560 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5561 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5562 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5563 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5564
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005565 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5566 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5567 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5568
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005569 Examples :
5570 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005571 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005572
5573 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5574 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5575 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5576
5577
5578 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5579 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5580 backend http
5581 mode http
5582 balance roundrobin
5583 stick on src table https
5584 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5585 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5586 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5587
5588 backend https
5589 mode tcp
5590 balance roundrobin
5591 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5592 stick on src
5593 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5594 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5595
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005596 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005597
5598
5599stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5600 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5602 no | no | yes | yes
5603
5604 Arguments :
5605 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5606 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5607 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5608 server is selected.
5609
5610 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5611 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5612 the "stick-table" statement.
5613
5614 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5615 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5616 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5617 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5618 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5619 address.
5620
5621 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5622 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5623 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5624 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5625 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5626 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5627 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5628 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5629 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5630 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5631
5632 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5633 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5634 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5635 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5636 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5637 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5638 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5639
5640 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5641 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5642 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5643 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5644
5645 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5646 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5647 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5648 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5649 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5650 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5651 another protocol or access method.
5652
5653 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5654 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5655 the request.
5656
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005657 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5658 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5659 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5660
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005661 Example :
5662 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5663 # last 30 minutes
5664 backend pop
5665 mode tcp
5666 balance roundrobin
5667 stick store-request src
5668 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5669 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5670 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5671
5672 backend smtp
5673 mode tcp
5674 balance roundrobin
5675 stick match src table pop
5676 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5677 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5678
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005679 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5680 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005681
5682
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005683stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005684 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5685 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005686 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005688 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005689
5690 Arguments :
5691 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5692 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5693 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5694 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5695
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005696 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5697 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5698 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5699 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5700
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005701 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5702 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5703 instance.
5704
5705 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5706 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5707 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5708 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5709 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5710 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005711 to 32 characters.
5712
5713 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5714 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5715 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5716 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5717 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5718 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005719
5720 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005721 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5722 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005723 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5724 increase.
5725
5726 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005727 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5728 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5729 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005730
5731 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5732 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5733 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5734 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5735 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5736 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5737 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5738 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5739 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5740 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5741 parameter (see below).
5742
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005743 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5744 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5745 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5746 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5747 soft restart.
5748
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005749 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5750
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005751 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5752 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5753 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5754 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5755 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005756 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005757 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5758 if not expiration delay is specified.
5759
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005760 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5761 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5762 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5763 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005764 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5765 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5766 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5767 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5768 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5769 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5770 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5771 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5772 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5773 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5774 types and their arguments.
5775
5776 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5777 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5778 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5779 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5780
5781 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5782 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5783 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5784 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5785
5786 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5787 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5788 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5789 they were received.
5790
5791 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5792 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5793 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5794 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5795 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5796
5797 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5798 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5799 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5800 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5801 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5802
5803 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5804 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5805 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5806
5807 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5808 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5809 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5810 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5811 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5812
5813 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5814 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5815 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5816 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5817 the client side.
5818
5819 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5820 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5821 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5822 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5823 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5824 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5825 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5826
5827 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5828 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5829 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5830 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5831 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5832 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5833 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5834
5835 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5836 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5837 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5838 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5839 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5840 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5841
5842 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5843 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5844 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5845 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5846
5847 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5848 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5849 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5850 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5851 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5852 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5853 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5854 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5855 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5856 recommended for better fairness.
5857
5858 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5859 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5860 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5861 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5862
5863 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5864 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5865 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5866 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5867 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5868 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5869 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5870 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5871 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5872 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005873
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005874 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5875 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005876 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5877 reference it.
5878
5879 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5880 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5881 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5882 as an exclusive stickiness.
5883
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005884 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5885 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5886 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5887 something that can be ignored.
5888
5889 Example:
5890 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5891 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5892 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5893 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5894
5895 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005896 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005897
5898
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005899stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5900 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5902 no | no | yes | yes
5903
5904 Arguments :
5905 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5906 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5907 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5908 server is selected.
5909
5910 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5911 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5912 the "stick-table" statement.
5913
5914 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5915 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5916 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5917 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5918
5919 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5920 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5921 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5922 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5923 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5924 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005925 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005926 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5927 rules.
5928
5929 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5930 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5931 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5932 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5933 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5934 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5935 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5936
5937 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5938 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5939 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5940 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5941
5942 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5943 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5944 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5945 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5946 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5947 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5948 another protocol or access method.
5949
5950 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5951
5952 Example :
5953 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5954 backend https
5955 mode tcp
5956 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005957 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005958 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005959
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005960 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5961 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5962
5963 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5964 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5965 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5966
5967 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5968 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005969
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005970 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5971 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5972 # at offset 44.
5973
5974 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5975 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5976
5977 # Learn on response if server hello.
5978 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005979
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005980 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5981 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5982
5983 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5984 extraction.
5985
5986
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005987tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5988 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5990 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005991 Arguments :
5992 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5993 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5994 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005996 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005997
5998 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5999 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006000 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6001 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6002 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6003 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6004 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6005 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006007 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6008 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6009 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6010 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006011
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006012 Three types of actions are supported :
6013 - accept :
6014 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6015 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6016 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006018 - reject :
6019 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6020 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6021 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6022 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6023 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6024 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6025 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6026 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6027 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6028 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6029 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6030 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006032 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6033 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6034 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6035 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6036 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6037 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6038 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6039 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6040 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006041
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006042 These actions take one or two arguments :
6043 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6044 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6045 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006047 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6048 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6049 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6050 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006052 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6053 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6054 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6055 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6056 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6057 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6058 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6059 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6060 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6061 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006063 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6064 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6065 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006066
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006067 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6068 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6069 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006070
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006071 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006072 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006073 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006075 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6076 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6077 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006078
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006079 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6080 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6081 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006082
6083 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6084
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006085 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006086
6087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006088tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6089 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006091 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006092 Arguments :
6093 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6094 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6095 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006096
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006097 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006098
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006099 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6100 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6101 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6102 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6103 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006105 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6106 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6107 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6108 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6109 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6110 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6111 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6112 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6113 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006114
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006115 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6116 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6117 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6118 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006120 Three types of actions are supported :
6121 - accept :
6122 - reject :
6123 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006125 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6126 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006128 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6129 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6130 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6131 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6132 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6133 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006135 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006136 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6137 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006139 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006140 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6141 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6142 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6143 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6144 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006145
6146 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006147 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6148 # and reject everything else.
6149 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6150 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006151 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006152 tcp-request content reject
6153
6154 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006155 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6156 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6157 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006158 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006159
6160 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6161 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6162 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006163 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006164 tcp-request content reject
6165
6166 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6167 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6168
6169 frontend http
6170 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6171 # protecting all our sites
6172 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6173 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6174 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6175 ...
6176 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6177
6178 backend http_dynamic
6179 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6180 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6181 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6182 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6183 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6184 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6185 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006187 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006188
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006189 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006190
6191
6192tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6193 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006195 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006196 Arguments :
6197 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6198 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6199 as explained at the top of this document.
6200
6201 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6202 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6203 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6204 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6205 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6206
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006207 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6208 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6209 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6210 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6211
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006212 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6213 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006214 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006215 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006216 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6217 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6218 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6219 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006220
6221 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6222 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6223 it pass through unaffected.
6224
6225 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6226 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6227 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006228 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006229 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6230 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006231 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6232 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6233 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006234
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006235 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006236 "timeout client".
6237
6238
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006239tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6240 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6242 no | no | yes | yes
6243 Arguments :
6244 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6245 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6246 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6247
6248 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6249
6250 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6251 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6252 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6253 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006254 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006255
6256 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6257
6258 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6259 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6260 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6261 inserted.
6262
6263 Two types of actions are supported :
6264 - accept :
6265 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6266 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6267 the rules evaluation.
6268
6269 - reject :
6270 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6271 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6272 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6273
6274 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6275 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6276 for changing the default action to a reject.
6277
6278 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6279 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6280 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6281 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6282 period.
6283
6284 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6285
6286 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6287
6288
6289tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6290 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6292 no | no | yes | yes
6293 Arguments :
6294 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6295 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6296 as explained at the top of this document.
6297
6298 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6299
6300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006301timeout check <timeout>
6302 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6303 established.
6304
6305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6306 yes | no | yes | yes
6307 Arguments:
6308 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6309 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6310 as explained at the top of this document.
6311
6312 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6313 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6314 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6315 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006316 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6317 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6318 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006319
6320 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6321 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6322
6323 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6324 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006325 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006326
6327 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6328 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6329 forget about it.
6330
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006331 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6332 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006333
6334
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006335timeout client <timeout>
6336timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6337 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6339 yes | yes | yes | no
6340 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006341 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006342 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6343 as explained at the top of this document.
6344
6345 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6346 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6347 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6348 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6349 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6350 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6351 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6352 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006353 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006354 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006355 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6356 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6357 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006358
6359 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6360 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6361 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6362 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6363 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6364 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6365
6366 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6367 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6368 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6369
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006370 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006371
6372
6373timeout connect <timeout>
6374timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6375 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6377 yes | no | yes | yes
6378 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006379 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006380 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6381 as explained at the top of this document.
6382
6383 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006384 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006385 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006386 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006387 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6388 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006389
6390 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6391 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6392 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6393 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6394 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6395 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6396
6397 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6398 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6399 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6400
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006401 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6402 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006403
6404
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006405timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6406 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6408 yes | yes | yes | yes
6409 Arguments :
6410 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6411 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6412 as explained at the top of this document.
6413
6414 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6415 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6416 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6417 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6418 once the request has started to present itself.
6419
6420 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6421 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6422 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6423 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6424 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6425
6426 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6427 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6428 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6429 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6430
6431 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6432 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6433 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6434 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6435 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006436 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006437
6438 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6439 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6440 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6441 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6442
6443 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6444
6445
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006446timeout http-request <timeout>
6447 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006449 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006450 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006451 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006452 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6453 as explained at the top of this document.
6454
6455 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6456 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6457 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6458 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6459 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6460 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6461 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6462 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6463
6464 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6465 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006466 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6467 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006468
6469 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6470 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6471 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6472 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6473 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6474
6475 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006476 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6477 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6478 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006479
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006480 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006481
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006482
6483timeout queue <timeout>
6484 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6486 yes | no | yes | yes
6487 Arguments :
6488 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6489 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6490 as explained at the top of this document.
6491
6492 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6493 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6494 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6495 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6496 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6497
6498 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6499 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6500 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6501 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6502
6503 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6504
6505
6506timeout server <timeout>
6507timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6508 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6510 yes | no | yes | yes
6511 Arguments :
6512 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6513 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6514 as explained at the top of this document.
6515
6516 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6517 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6518 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6519 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6520 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6521 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6522 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6523
6524 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6525 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6526 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6527 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6528 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006529 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006530 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006531 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6532 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6533 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6534 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006535
6536 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6537 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6538 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6539 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6540 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6541 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6542
6543 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6544 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6545 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6546
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006547 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006548
6549
6550timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006551 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6553 yes | yes | yes | yes
6554 Arguments :
6555 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6556 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6557 as explained at the top of this document.
6558
6559 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6560 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6561 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6562
6563 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6564 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6565 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6566 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006567 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006568
6569 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6570
6571
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006572timeout tunnel <timeout>
6573 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6575 yes | no | yes | yes
6576 Arguments :
6577 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6578 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6579 as explained at the top of this document.
6580
6581 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectionnal connection is established
6582 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6583 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6584 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6585 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6586 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6587 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6588 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6589 specified.
6590
6591 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6592 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6593 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6594 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6595 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6596
6597 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6598 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6599 forget about it.
6600
6601 Example :
6602 defaults http
6603 option http-server-close
6604 timeout connect 5s
6605 timeout client 30s
6606 timeout client 30s
6607 timeout server 30s
6608 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6609
6610 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6611
6612
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006613transparent (deprecated)
6614 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006616 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006617 Arguments : none
6618
6619 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6620 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6621 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6622 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6623 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6624 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6625 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6626 appropriate server.
6627
6628 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6629
6630 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6631 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6632
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006633 See also: "option transparent"
6634
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006635unique-id-format <string>
6636 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6638 yes | yes | yes | no
6639 Arguments :
6640 <string> is a log-format string.
6641
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006642 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6643 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6644 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6645 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006646
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006647 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6648 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6649 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6650 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6651 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6652 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6653 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6654 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006655
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006656 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6657 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006658
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006659 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006660
6661 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6662
6663 will generate:
6664
6665 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6666
6667 See also: "unique-id-header"
6668
6669unique-id-header <name>
6670 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6672 yes | yes | yes | no
6673 Arguments :
6674 <name> is the name of the header.
6675
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006676 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6677 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006678
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006679 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006680
6681 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6682 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6683
6684 will generate:
6685
6686 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6687
6688 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006689
6690use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6691use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006692 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6694 no | yes | yes | no
6695 Arguments :
6696 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006698 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006699
6700 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6701 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6702 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006703 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6704 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6705 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6706 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006707
6708 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6709 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6710 assign the backend.
6711
6712 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6713 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6714 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6715 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6716 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6717 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6718
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006719 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006720 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006721 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6722 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6723 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6724
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006725 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006726
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006727
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006728use-server <server> if <condition>
6729use-server <server> unless <condition>
6730 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6732 no | no | yes | yes
6733 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006734 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006735
6736 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6737
6738 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6739 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6740 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6741
6742 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6743 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6744 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6745 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6746 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6747 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6748 matches will assign the server.
6749
6750 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6751 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6752 with the next rules until one matches.
6753
6754 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6755 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6756 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6757 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6758
6759 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6760 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6761 stripped.
6762
6763 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6764 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6765 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6766 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6767
6768 Example :
6769 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6770 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6771 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6772 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6773 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6774 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6775 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6776 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6777 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6778
6779 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6780
6781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010067825. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006783------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006785The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6786which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6787arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6788settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6789after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6790Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6791address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006793 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006794 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006795
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006796The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006797
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006798addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006799 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6800 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6801 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6802 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6803 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006805 Supported in default-server: No
6806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006807backup
6808 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6809 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6810 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6811 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6812 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6813 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006815 Supported in default-server: No
6816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006817check
6818 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006819 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6820 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6821 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6822 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6823 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6824 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6825 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6826 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6827 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6828 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006830 Supported in default-server: No
6831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006832cookie <value>
6833 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6834 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6835 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6836 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6837 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6838 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6839 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006841 Supported in default-server: No
6842
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006843disabled
6844 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6845 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6846 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6847 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6848 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6849
6850 Supported in default-server: No
6851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006852error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006853 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6854 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6855 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006857 Supported in default-server: Yes
6858
6859 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006860
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006861fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006862 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6863 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6864 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006866 Supported in default-server: Yes
6867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006868id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006869 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6870 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6871 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006873 Supported in default-server: No
6874
6875inter <delay>
6876fastinter <delay>
6877downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006878 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6879 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6880 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6881 between checks depending on the server state :
6882
6883 Server state | Interval used
6884 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6885 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6886 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6887 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6888 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6889 or yet unchecked. |
6890 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6891 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6892 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006894 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6895 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6896 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6897 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6898 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6899 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6900 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6901 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6902 servers.
6903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006904 Supported in default-server: Yes
6905
6906maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006907 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6908 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6909 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6910 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6911 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6912 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6913 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6914 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006916 Supported in default-server: Yes
6917
6918maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006919 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6920 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6921 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6922 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6923 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6924 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6925 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006927 Supported in default-server: Yes
6928
6929minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006930 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6931 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6932 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6933 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6934 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6935 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006936 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006937 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006939 Supported in default-server: Yes
6940
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006941non-stick
6942 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6943 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6944 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006946observe <mode>
6947 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6948 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6949 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6950 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6951 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6952 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01006953 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006955 Supported in default-server: No
6956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006957 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6958
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006959on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006960 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6961 Currently, four modes are available:
6962 - fastinter: force fastinter
6963 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6964 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6965 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6966 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006968 Supported in default-server: Yes
6969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006970 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6971
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006972on-marked-down <action>
6973 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6974 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07006975 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
6976 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
6977 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
6978 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
6979 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
6980 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
6981 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
6982 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006983
6984 Actions are disabled by default
6985
6986 Supported in default-server: Yes
6987
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07006988on-marked-up <action>
6989 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
6990 Currently one action is available:
6991 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
6992 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
6993 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
6994 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
6995 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
6996 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
6997 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
6998 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
6999
7000 Actions are disabled by default
7001
7002 Supported in default-server: Yes
7003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007004port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007005 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7006 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7007 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7008 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7009 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7010 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007012 Supported in default-server: Yes
7013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007014redir <prefix>
7015 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7016 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7017 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7018 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7019 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7020 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7021 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7022 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007023 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007024 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7025 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7026 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7027 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7028 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7029
7030 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007032 Supported in default-server: No
7033
7034rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007035 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7036 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7037 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007039 Supported in default-server: Yes
7040
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007041send-proxy
7042 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7043 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7044 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7045 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7046 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7047 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7048 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7049 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7050 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7051 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7052 option of the "bind" keyword.
7053
7054 Supported in default-server: No
7055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007056slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007057 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7058 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7059 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7060 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7061 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7062 parameters :
7063
7064 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7065 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7066
7067 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7068 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7069 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7070 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7071
7072 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7073 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7074 seen as failed.
7075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007076 Supported in default-server: Yes
7077
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007078source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007079source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007080source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007081 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7082 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7083 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7084 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7085
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007086 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7087 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7088 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7089 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7090 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7091 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7092 server.
7093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007094 Supported in default-server: No
7095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007096track [<proxy>/]<server>
7097 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7098 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7099 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7100 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7101 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7102
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007103 Supported in default-server: No
7104
7105weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007106 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7107 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7108 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007109 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7110 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7111 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7112 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7113 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7114 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007116 Supported in default-server: Yes
7117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007118
71196. HTTP header manipulation
7120---------------------------
7121
7122In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7123response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7124request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7125which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7126against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7127to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7128passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7129headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7130never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7131
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007132There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7133(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7134rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7135messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7136in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007137happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007138add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7139normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007141This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7142in section 4.2 :
7143
7144 - reqadd <string>
7145 - reqallow <search>
7146 - reqiallow <search>
7147 - reqdel <search>
7148 - reqidel <search>
7149 - reqdeny <search>
7150 - reqideny <search>
7151 - reqpass <search>
7152 - reqipass <search>
7153 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7154 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7155 - reqtarpit <search>
7156 - reqitarpit <search>
7157 - rspadd <string>
7158 - rspdel <search>
7159 - rspidel <search>
7160 - rspdeny <search>
7161 - rspideny <search>
7162 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7163 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7164
7165With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7166is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7167parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7168prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7169Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7170
7171 \t for a tab
7172 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7173 \n for a new line (LF)
7174 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7175 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7176 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7177 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7178 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7179
7180The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7181portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7182above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7183regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
71849 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7185is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7186
7187The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7188after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7189
7190Notes related to these keywords :
7191---------------------------------
7192 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7193 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7194 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7195
7196 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7197 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7198 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7199
7200 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7201 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7202 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7203 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7204 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7205
7206 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7207 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7208 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7209 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7210 useless headers before adding new ones.
7211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007212 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7214
7215 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7216 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7217 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7218
7219 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7220 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007221 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007222
7223
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010072247. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7225------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007226
7227The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7228content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7229from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7230simple :
7231
7232 - define test criteria with sets of values
7233 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7234
7235The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7236
7237In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7238
7239 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7240
7241This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7242Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7243and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7244an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7245of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7246
7247ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7248'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7249which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7250
7251There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7252performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7253
7254The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7255
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007256 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7257 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007258 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7259
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007260The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7261specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7262possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007263multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7264be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7265needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7266space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7267match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7268lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7269duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7270to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7271instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007272
7273 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7274
7275In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7276the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7277case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7278too.
7279
7280Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7281a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7282ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7283
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007284Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007285
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007286 - integers or integer ranges
7287 - strings
7288 - regular expressions
7289 - IP addresses and networks
7290
7291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072927.1. Matching integers
7293----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007294
7295Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7296that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7297expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7298may be omitted.
7299
7300For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7301unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7302representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7303
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007304As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7305two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7306instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7307ranges and operators.
7308
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007309For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007310operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7311Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7312of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007313
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007314Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007315
7316 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7317 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7318 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7319 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7320 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007322For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007323
7324 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7325
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007326This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7327
7328 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7329
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073317.2. Matching strings
7332---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007333
7334String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7335exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7336characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7337string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7338to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007339before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007340
7341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073427.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7343-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007344
7345Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7346they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7347possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7348passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7349the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007350the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7351match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007352
7353
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020073547.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007355----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007356
7357IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7358netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7359within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007360host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007361difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7362at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7363does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7364parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007365
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007366IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7367Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7368trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7369IPv6 patterns.
7370
7371HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7372following situations :
7373 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7374 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7375 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7376 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7377 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7378 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7379 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7380 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7381 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7382 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7383
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073857.5. Available matching criteria
7386--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073887.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7389------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007390
7391A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7392analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7393addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7394
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007395always_false
7396 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7397 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7398
7399always_true
7400 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7401 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7402
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007403avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007404avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007405 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7406 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7407 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7408 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7409 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7410 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7411 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7412 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7413 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7414 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7415 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007416
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007417be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007418be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007419 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7420 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7421 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7422 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7423 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007424
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007425be_id <integer>
7426 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7427 backend it was called.
7428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007429be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007430be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007431 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7432 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7433 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7434 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7435 sucking of an online dictionary).
7436
7437 Example :
7438 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7439 backend dynamic
7440 mode http
7441 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7442 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007443
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007444connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007445connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007446 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007447 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007448 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7449
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007450 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7451 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007452
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007453 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007454 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7455 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7456 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7457 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7458 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007459 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007460
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007461 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7462 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7463 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7464 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007465
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007466dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007467 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7468 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007469
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007470dst_conn <integer>
7471 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7472 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7473 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7474 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7475 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7476 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7477
7478dst_port <integer>
7479 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7480 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7481
7482fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007483fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007484 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7485 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7486 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7487 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7488 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7489 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7490 criteria.
7491
7492fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007493 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007494 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007495
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007496fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007497fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007498 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7499 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7500 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7501 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7502 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7503 the rate to go down below the limit.
7504
7505 Example :
7506 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7507 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7508 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7509 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7510 frontend mail
7511 bind :25
7512 mode tcp
7513 maxconn 100
7514 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7515 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7516 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7517 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007518
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007519nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007520nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007521 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7522 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7523 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7524 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7525 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007526
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007527queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007528queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007529 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7530 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7531 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7532 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7533 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7534 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7535 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7536
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007537sc1_bytes_in_rate
7538sc2_bytes_in_rate
7539 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7540 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7541 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7542
7543sc1_bytes_out_rate
7544sc2_bytes_out_rate
7545 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7546 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7547 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7548
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007549sc1_clr_gpc0
7550sc2_clr_gpc0
7551 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7552 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7553 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7554 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7555 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7556 was verified :
7557
7558 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7559 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7560 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7561 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7562 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7563 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7564 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7565
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007566sc1_conn_cnt
7567sc2_conn_cnt
7568 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7569 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7570
7571sc1_conn_cur
7572sc2_conn_cur
7573 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7574 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7575 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7576
7577sc1_conn_rate
7578sc2_conn_rate
7579 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7580 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7581 See also src_conn_rate.
7582
7583sc1_get_gpc0
7584sc2_get_gpc0
7585 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7586 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7587
7588sc1_http_err_cnt
7589sc2_http_err_cnt
7590 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7591 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7592 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7593
7594sc1_http_err_rate
7595sc2_http_err_rate
7596 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7597 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7598 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7599 src_http_err_rate.
7600
7601sc1_http_req_cnt
7602sc2_http_req_cnt
7603 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7604 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7605 src_http_req_cnt.
7606
7607sc1_http_req_rate
7608sc2_http_req_rate
7609 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7610 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7611 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7612 src_http_req_rate.
7613
7614sc1_inc_gpc0
7615sc2_inc_gpc0
7616 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7617 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7618 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7619 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7620 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7621 when a first ACL was verified :
7622
7623 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7624 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7625 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7626
7627sc1_kbytes_in
7628sc2_kbytes_in
7629 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7630 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7631 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7632 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7633
7634sc1_kbytes_out
7635sc2_kbytes_out
7636 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7637 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7638 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7639 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7640
7641sc1_sess_cnt
7642sc2_sess_cnt
7643 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7644 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7645 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7646 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7647 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7648 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7649
7650sc1_sess_rate
7651sc2_sess_rate
7652 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7653 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7654 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7655 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7656 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7657 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7658
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007659so_id <integer>
7660 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7661
7662src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007663 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7664 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7665 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007666
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007667src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007668src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007669 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7670 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7671 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007672 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007673
7674src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007675src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007676 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7677 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7678 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007679 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007680
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007681src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7682src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7683 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7684 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7685 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7686 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7687 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7688 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7689
7690 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7691 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7692 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7693 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7694 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7695 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7696 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7697
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007698src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007699src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007700 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7701 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7702 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007703 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007704
7705src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007706src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007707 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7708 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7709 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007710 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007711
7712src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007713src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007714 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7715 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7716 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007717 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007718
7719src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007720src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007721 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7722 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7723 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007724 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007725
7726src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007727src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007728 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7729 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7730 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007731 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007732
7733src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007734src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007735 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7736 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7737 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7738 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007739 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007740
7741src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007742src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007743 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7744 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7745 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007746 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007747
7748src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007749src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007750 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7751 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7752 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7753 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007754 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007755
7756src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007757src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007758 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7759 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7760 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7761 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7762 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7763 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7764
7765 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7766 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007767 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007768
7769src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007770src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007771 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7772 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7773 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7774 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007775 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007776
7777src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007778src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007779 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7780 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7781 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7782 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007783 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007784
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007785src_port <integer>
7786 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007787
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007788src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007789src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007790 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7791 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7792 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7793 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007794 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007795
7796src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007797src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007798 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7799 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7800 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7801 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007802 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007803
7804src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007805src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007806 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007807 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7808 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007809 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7810 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7811 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007812 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007813
7814 Example :
7815 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7816 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7817 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7818 listen ssh
7819 bind :22
7820 mode tcp
7821 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007822 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007823 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7824 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7825
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007826srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007827 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7828 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7829 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7830 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7831
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007832srv_id <integer>
7833 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7834
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007835srv_is_up(<server>)
7836srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7837 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7838 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7839 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7840 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7841 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7842 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7843 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7844 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7845
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007846table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007847table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007848 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7849 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7850
7851table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007852table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007853 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7854 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7855 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007857
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020078587.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7859---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007860
7861A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7862during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007863through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7864keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007865
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007866rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7867 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7868 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7869 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7870 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7871
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007872req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007873 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007874 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7875 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7876 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7877 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7878 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7879 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7880
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007881req_proto_http
7882 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7883 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007884 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007885 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7886 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7887
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007888req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007889req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007890 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7891 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7892 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7893 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7894 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7895 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7896 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7897 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7898
7899req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007900req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007901 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7902 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7903 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7904 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7905 cookies.
7906
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007907req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7908 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7909 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7910 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7911 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7912
7913req_ssl_sni <string>
7914 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7915 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7916 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7917 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7918 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7919 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7920 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7921 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7922
7923 Examples :
7924 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7925 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7926 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7927 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7928 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7929
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007930req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7931 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7932 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7933 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7934 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7935 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7936 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7937 with TCP request content inspection.
7938
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007939wait_end
7940 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7941 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7942 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7943 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7944 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7945 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7946 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7947 inspection.
7948
7949 Examples :
7950 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7951 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7952 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7953
7954 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7955 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7956 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7957 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7958 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7959 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7960 tcp-request content reject
7961
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079637.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7964--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007965
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007966A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007967application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7968read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7969than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7970
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02007971base <string>
7972 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
7973 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
7974 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
7975 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
7976 See also "path" and "uri".
7977
7978base_beg <string>
7979 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
7980 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
7981 "path_beg".
7982
7983base_dir <string>
7984 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7985 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
7986 "path_dir" instead.
7987
7988base_dom <string>
7989 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7990 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
7991 instead.
7992
7993base_end <string>
7994 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
7995 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
7996
7997base_len <integer>
7998 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
7999 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8000
8001base_reg <regex>
8002 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8003 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8004 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8005 and all "base_" criteria.
8006
8007base_sub <string>
8008 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8009 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8010 also "base_dir".
8011
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008012cook(<name>) <string>
8013 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8014 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8015 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8016 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8017 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8018 sent by the server.
8019
8020 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8021 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8022 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8023
8024 cook(profile) silver gold
8025
8026cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8027 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8028 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8029 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8030
8031cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8032 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8033 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8034 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8035 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8036 server.
8037
8038cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8039 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8040 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8041 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8042 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8043 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8044
8045cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8046 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8047 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8048 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8049 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8050
8051cook_end(<name>) <string>
8052 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8053 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8054 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8055
8056cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8057 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8058 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8059 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8060 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8061 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8062
8063cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8064 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8065 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8066 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8067 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8068 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8069
8070cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8071 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8072 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8073 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8074
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008075cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8076 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8077 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8078 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8079 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8080 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8081
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008082hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008083hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008084 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8085 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8086 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8087 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008088 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8089 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8090 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8091 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8092 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008093
8094 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008095 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008096 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8097
8098 hdr(Connection) -i close
8099
8100hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008101hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008102 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8103 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8104 response headers sent by the server.
8105
8106hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008107hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008108 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8109 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8110 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8111 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8112 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8113 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8114 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8115
8116hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008117hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008118 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8119 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8120 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8121 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8122 headers sent by the server.
8123
8124hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008125hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008126 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8127 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8128 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8129 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8130 server.
8131
8132hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008133hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008134 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8135 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8136 response headers sent by the server.
8137
8138hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008139hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8140 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8141 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8142 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008143 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8144
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008145hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008146hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008147 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8148 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8149 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8150 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8151
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008152hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008153hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008154 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008155 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8156 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8157 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8158 response headers sent by the server.
8159
8160hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008161hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008162 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8163 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8164 response headers sent by the server.
8165
8166hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008167hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008168 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8169 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8170 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8171 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8172
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008173http_auth(<userlist>)
8174http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008175 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8176 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8177 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8178 of specified groups.
8179
8180 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8181
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008182http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008183 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8184 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8185 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8186 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8187
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008188method <string>
8189 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8190 already check for most common methods.
8191
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008192path <string>
8193 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8194 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8195 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8196
8197path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008198 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8199 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008200
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008201path_dir <string>
8202 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8203 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8204 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8205 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8206
8207path_dom <string>
8208 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8209 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8210 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8211
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008212path_end <string>
8213 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8214 control file name extension.
8215
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008216path_len <integer>
8217 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8218 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8219
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008220path_reg <regex>
8221 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8222 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8223 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8224
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008225path_sub <string>
8226 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8227 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8228 "path_dir".
8229
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008230payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8231 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8232 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8233 strings.
8234
8235payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8236 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8237 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8238 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8239 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8240 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8241
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008242req_ver <string>
8243 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8244 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8245
8246status <integer>
8247 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8248 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8249 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8250
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008251url <string>
8252 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008253 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008254
8255url_beg <string>
8256 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008257 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8258 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008260url_dir <string>
8261 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8262 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8263 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8264 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8265
8266url_dom <string>
8267 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8268 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8269 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8270
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008271url_end <string>
8272 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8273 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008274
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008275url_ip <address>
8276 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8277 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8278 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008279
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008280url_len <integer>
8281 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8282 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8283
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008284url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008285 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8286 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008287 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008288 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008289
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008290url_reg <regex>
8291 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8292 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008293 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008294
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008295url_sub <string>
8296 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8297 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008298
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008299urlp(<name>) <string>
8300 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8301 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8302
8303 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8304 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8305
8306urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8307 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8308 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8309 protocol scheme.
8310
8311urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8312 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8313 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8314 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8315 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8316
8317urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8318 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8319 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8320 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8321 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8322
8323urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8324 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8325
8326urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008327 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8328 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008329
8330urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8331 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8332 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8333
8334urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8335 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8336 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8337 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8338 "urlp_" criteria.
8339
8340urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8341 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8342 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8343 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8344
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008345urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8346 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8347 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8348 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8349 negative data.
8350
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083527.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8353---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008355Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8356every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008357order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008359ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8360---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008361FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008362HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008363HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8364HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008365HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8366HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8367HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8368HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8369LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008370METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8371METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8372METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8373METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8374METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8375METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008376RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008377REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008378TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008379WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8380---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008381
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083837.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8384----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008386Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8387combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008389 - AND (implicit)
8390 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8391 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008393A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008395 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008397Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8398indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008400For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8401"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8402requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8403is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008405 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8406 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8407 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8408 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008410To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8411and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008413 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8414 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8415 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8416 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008418 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8419 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8420 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8421 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008422
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008423It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8424expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8425be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8426the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
8427
8428 The following rule :
8429
8430 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8431 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8432
8433 Can also be written that way :
8434
8435 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8436
8437It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8438to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8439simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8440sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8441good use is the following :
8442
8443 With named ACLs :
8444
8445 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8446 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8447 monitor fail if site_dead
8448
8449 With anonymous ACLs :
8450
8451 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008453See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008454
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008455
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010084567.8. Pattern extraction
8457-----------------------
8458
8459The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8460response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8461for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8462
8463All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8464"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8465begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8466arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8467much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8468equivalent used in ACLs.
8469
8470The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8471
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008472 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8473 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8474 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8475 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8476 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8477 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8478 requested objects by host/path.
8479
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008480 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008481 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8482 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8483 according to RFC 4291.
8484
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008485 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8486 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8487 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008488 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8489 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8490 according to RFC 4291.
8491
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008492 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8493 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8494 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8495 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8496 type integer and only works with such tables.
8497
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008498 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8499 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8500 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8501 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8502 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8503 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8504 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008505 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008506
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008507 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
8508 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8509 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8510 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
8511 wiser to use "url" instead.
8512
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008513 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008514 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8515 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8516 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8517 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008518
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008519 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008520 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8521 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8522 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8523 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8524 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8525 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8526 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8527 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008528
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008529 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8530 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8531 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8532 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8533
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008534 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
8535 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8536 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8537 keep them in caches. See also "path".
8538
8539 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
8540 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
8541 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
8542 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
8543 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
8544 table for a given source address.
8545
8546 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
8547 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
8548
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008549 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008550 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8551 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8552 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8553 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8554 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008555
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008556 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008557 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8558 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8559 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8560 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008561
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008562 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8563 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8564 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8565 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8566 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8567 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8568 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008569
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008570 Example :
8571 listen tse-farm
8572 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8573 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8574 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8575 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8576 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8577 persist rdp-cookie
8578 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8579 # This is only useful makes sense if
8580 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8581 stick-table type string size 204800
8582 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8583 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8584 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008585
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008586 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8587 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008588
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008589 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008590 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008591 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8592 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8593 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8594 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8595 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8596 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008597
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008598 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008599
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008600 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008601 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8602 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8603 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8604
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008605 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8606 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8607 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8608 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8609 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008610
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008611 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008612
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008613
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008614The currently available list of transformations include :
8615
8616 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8617 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8618 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8619
8620 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8621 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8622 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8623
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008624 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008625 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8626 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8627 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8628 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8629
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086318. Logging
8632----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008633
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008634One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8635provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8636very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8637provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8638state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008639to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008640headers.
8641
8642In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8643about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8644send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8645
8646 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8647 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8648 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8649 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8650 at the termination.
8651
8652The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8653allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8654as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8655while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8656real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8657delay.
8658
8659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086608.1. Log levels
8661---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008662
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008663TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008664source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008665HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8666in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8667track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8668syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8669about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008670
8671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086728.2. Log formats
8673----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008674
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008675HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008676and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8677slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8678options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008679
8680 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8681 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8682 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8683 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8684 extents.
8685
8686 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8687 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8688 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8689 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8690 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8691
8692 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8693 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8694 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8695 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8696 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8697
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008698 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8699 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8700 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8701 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8702
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008703 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8704
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008705Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8706specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8707field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8708servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8709always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8710identifier.
8711
8712Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8713 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8714 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8715 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8716 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8717
8718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087198.2.1. Default log format
8720-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008721
8722This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8723as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8724format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8725
8726 Example :
8727 listen www
8728 mode http
8729 log global
8730 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8731
8732 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8733 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8734 (www/HTTP)
8735
8736 Field Format Extract from the example above
8737 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8738 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8739 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8740 4 'to' to
8741 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8742 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8743
8744Detailed fields description :
8745 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8746 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8747 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8748 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8749 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8750 and processed the connection.
8751 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8752
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008753In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8754"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8755connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8756
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008757It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8758will eventually disappear.
8759
8760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087618.2.2. TCP log format
8762---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008763
8764The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8765is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8766information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8767counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8768emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8769environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8770the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8771sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008772specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8773not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8774fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8775marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008776
8777 Example :
8778 frontend fnt
8779 mode tcp
8780 option tcplog
8781 log global
8782 default_backend bck
8783
8784 backend bck
8785 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8786
8787 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8788 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8789 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8790
8791 Field Format Extract from the example above
8792 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8793 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8794 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8795 4 frontend_name fnt
8796 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8797 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8798 7 bytes_read* 212
8799 8 termination_state --
8800 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8801 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8802
8803Detailed fields description :
8804 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008805 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8806 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8807 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8808 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8809 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008810
8811 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008812 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8813 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8814 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008815
8816 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8817 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8818 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8819 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8820
8821 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8822 and processed the connection.
8823
8824 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8825 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8826 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8827 applications.
8828
8829 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8830 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8831 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8832 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8833 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8834
8835 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8836 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8837 See "Timers" below for more details.
8838
8839 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8840 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8841 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8842 "Timers" below for more details.
8843
8844 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8845 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8846 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8847 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8848 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8849 details.
8850
8851 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8852 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8853 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8854 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8855 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8856
8857 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8858 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8859 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8860 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8861 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8862 for more details.
8863
8864 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8865 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8866 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8867 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8868 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008869 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008870
8871 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8872 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8873 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8874 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8875 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8876 caused by a denial of service attack.
8877
8878 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8879 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8880 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8881 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8882 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8883 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8884 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8885 denial of service attack.
8886
8887 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8888 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8889 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8890 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8891 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8892 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8893 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8894 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8895 be processed than on other servers.
8896
8897 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8898 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8899 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8900 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8901 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8902 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8903 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8904 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8905 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8906 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8907 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8908 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8909 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8910
8911 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8912 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8913 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8914 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8915 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8916 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8917 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8918 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8919
8920 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8921 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8922 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8923 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8924 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8925 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8926 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8927 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8928 occurs.
8929
8930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089318.2.3. HTTP log format
8932----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008933
8934The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8935is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8936the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8937are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8938emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8939generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8940"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8941which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008942frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8943is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008944
8945Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8946slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8947with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8948
8949 Example :
8950 frontend http-in
8951 mode http
8952 option httplog
8953 log global
8954 default_backend bck
8955
8956 backend static
8957 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8958
8959 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8960 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8961 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008962 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008963
8964 Field Format Extract from the example above
8965 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8966 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8967 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8968 4 frontend_name http-in
8969 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8970 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8971 7 status_code 200
8972 8 bytes_read* 2750
8973 9 captured_request_cookie -
8974 10 captured_response_cookie -
8975 11 termination_state ----
8976 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8977 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8978 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8979 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8980 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008981
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008982
8983Detailed fields description :
8984 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008985 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8986 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8987 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8988 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8989 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008990
8991 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008992 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8993 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8994 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008995
8996 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8997 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8998 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8999 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9000 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9001
9002 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9003 and processed the connection.
9004
9005 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9006 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9007 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9008
9009 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9010 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9011 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9012 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9013 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9014 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9015
9016 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9017 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9018 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9019 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9020 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9021 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9022
9023 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9024 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9025 See "Timers" below for more details.
9026
9027 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9028 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9029 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9030 below for more details.
9031
9032 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9033 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9034 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9035 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9036 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9037 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9038 for more details.
9039
9040 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9041 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9042 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9043 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9044 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9045 details.
9046
9047 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9048 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9049 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9050
9051 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9052 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9053 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9054 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9055 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9056 overflowing.
9057
9058 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9059 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9060 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9061 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9062 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9063 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9064 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9065 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9066
9067 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9068 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9069 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9070 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9071 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9072 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9073 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9074 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9075
9076 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9077 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9078 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9079 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9080 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9081 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9082 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9083
9084 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
9085 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
9086 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9087 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9088 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009089 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009090 system.
9091
9092 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9093 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9094 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9095 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9096 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9097 caused by a denial of service attack.
9098
9099 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9100 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9101 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9102 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9103 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9104 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9105 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9106 denial of service attack.
9107
9108 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9109 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9110 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9111 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9112 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9113 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9114 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9115 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9116 processed than on other servers.
9117
9118 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9119 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9120 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9121 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9122 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9123 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9124 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9125 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9126 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9127 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9128 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9129 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9130 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9131
9132 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9133 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9134 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9135 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9136 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9137 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9138 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9139 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9140
9141 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9142 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9143 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9144 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9145 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9146 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9147 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9148 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9149 occurs.
9150
9151 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9152 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9153 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9154 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9155 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9156 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9157 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9158 cookies" below for more details.
9159
9160 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9161 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9162 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9163 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9164 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9165 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9166 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9167 and cookies" below for more details.
9168
9169 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9170 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9171 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9172 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9173 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9174 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9175 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9176 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9177
9178
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020091798.2.4. Custom log format
9180------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009181
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009182The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9183mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009184
9185HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9186Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9187separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9188prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9189
9190Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9191variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9192string formats ("Q").
9193
9194Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9195HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9196
9197Flags are :
9198 * Q: quote a string
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009199 * X: hexadecimal represenation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009200
9201 Example:
9202
9203 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9204 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9205
9206At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9207
9208 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009209 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009210
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009211the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009212
9213 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009214 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009215 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9216
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009217and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9218
9219 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9220 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9221
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009222Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9223
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009224 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9225 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9226 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9227 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9228 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9229 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009230 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009231 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009232 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009233 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009234 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9235 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9236 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009237 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009238 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9239 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9240 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009241 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9242 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9243 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009244 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009245 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9246 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9247 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9248 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9249 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9250 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9251 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009252 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009253 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9254 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9255 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9256 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9257 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9258 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9259 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9260 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009261 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009262 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9263 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9264 | | %s | server_name | string |
9265 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9266 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9267 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009268 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009269 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009270 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009271 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009272
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009273*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092758.3. Advanced logging options
9276-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009277
9278Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9279just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9280options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9281for more information about their usage.
9282
9283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9285------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009286
9287It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9288haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9289commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9290monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9291ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9292
9293 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9294 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9295 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9296 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9297
9298 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9299 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9300 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9301 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9302 such as other load-balancers.
9303
9304 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9305 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9306 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9307
9308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093098.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9310----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009311
9312The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9313what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9314or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9315"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9316just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9317log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9318after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9319is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9320with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9321with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9322
9323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093248.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9325------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009326
9327Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9328for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9329"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9330retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9331raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9332a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9333file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9334you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9335"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9336
9337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093388.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9339--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009340
9341Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9342multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9343them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9344"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9345logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9346error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9347and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9348too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9349useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9350alternative.
9351
9352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093538.4. Timing events
9354------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009355
9356Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9357reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9358the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9359frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9360mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9361
9362 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9363 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9364 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9365 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9366 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9367
9368 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9369 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9370 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9371 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9372 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9373
9374 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9375 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9376 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9377 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9378 connection never established.
9379
9380 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9381 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9382 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9383 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9384 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9385 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9386 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9387 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9388 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9389 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9390 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9391
9392 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9393 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9394 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9395 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9396 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9397
9398 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9399
9400 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9401 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9402 negative.
9403
9404These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9405protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9406that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009407due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009408close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9409session has been aborted on timeout.
9410
9411Most common cases :
9412
9413 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9414 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9415 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9416 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9417 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9418 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9419 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9420 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9421 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009422 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9423 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9424 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009425
9426 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9427 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9428 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9429 of ms on remote networks.
9430
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009431 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9432 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9433 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009434
9435 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9436 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9437 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9438 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9439 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9440 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9441 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9442 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9443 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9444 to the server until another one is released.
9445
9446Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9447
9448 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9449 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9450 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9451
9452 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9453 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9454 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9455
9456 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9457 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9458 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9459 flags.
9460
9461 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9462 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9463 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9464 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9465 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9466 the client connection was maintained open.
9467
9468 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9469 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9470 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9471 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9472
9473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094748.5. Session state at disconnection
9475-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009476
9477TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9478"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
94792-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9480each of which has a special meaning :
9481
9482 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9483 session to terminate :
9484
9485 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9486
9487 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9488 server explicitly refused it.
9489
9490 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9491 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9492 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9493 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9494 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9495 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9496
9497 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9498 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9499 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9500 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9501 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9502
9503 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9504 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9505 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9506 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9507 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9508
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009509 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9510 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9511
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009512 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9513 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9514 backup connections when going up.
9515
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009516 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9517
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009518 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9519 send or receive data.
9520
9521 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9522 send or receive data.
9523
9524 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9525 with nothing left in the buffers.
9526
9527 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9528
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009529 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009530 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9531
9532 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9533 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9534 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9535 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9536 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9537
9538 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9539 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9540
9541 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9542 server (HTTP only).
9543
9544 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9545
9546 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9547 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9548 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9549
9550 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9551 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9552 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9553
9554 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9555
9556 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9557 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9558
9559 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9560 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9561 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9562
9563 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9564 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009565 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9566 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009567
9568 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9569 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9570 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9571 another server.
9572
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009573 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009574 server.
9575
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009576 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9577 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9578 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9579 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9580
9581 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9582 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9583 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9584 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9585
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009586 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9587 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9588 "use-server" rule).
9589
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009590 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9591
9592 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9593 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9594
9595 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9596
9597 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9598 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9599 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9600
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009601 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9602 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9603 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9604 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9605 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9606
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009607 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9608
9609 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9610 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9611
9612 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9613
9614 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9615
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009616The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9617was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009618helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9619starvation, attacks, etc...
9620
9621The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9622alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9623easier finding and understanding.
9624
9625 Flags Reason
9626
9627 -- Normal termination.
9628
9629 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9630 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9631 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9632 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9633
9634 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9635 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9636 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9637 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9638 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9639 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009640
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009641 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9642 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009643 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009644
9645 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9646 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9647 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9648
9649 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9650 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9651 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9652 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9653 the server takes too long to respond.
9654
9655 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9656 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9657 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9658 long a time to respond.
9659
9660 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9661 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9662 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9663 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9664 and the client.
9665
9666 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9667 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9668 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9669 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9670 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9671 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9672
9673 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9674 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009675 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9676 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9677 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9678 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009679
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009680 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009681 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9682 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9683 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9684 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9685 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9686
9687 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9688 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9689 503 or 504 here.
9690
9691 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9692 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9693 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9694 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9695 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9696
9697 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9698 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009699 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009700 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9701 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9702
9703 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9704 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9705 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9706 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9707 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9708 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9709 between haproxy and the server.
9710
9711 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9712 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9713 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9714 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9715 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9716 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9717 solution is to fix the application.
9718
9719 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9720 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9721 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9722 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9723 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9724 external attacks.
9725
9726 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9727 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009728 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009729 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9730 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9731
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009732 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9733 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9734 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9735 the client.
9736
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009737 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9738 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9739 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9740 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009741 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9742 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9743 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9744 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9745 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009746
9747 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9748 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9749 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9750 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9751
9752 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9753 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9754 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9755 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9756
9757 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9758 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9759 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9760 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9761
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009762The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9763persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9764important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9765re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9766
9767 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9768
9769 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9770 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9771 set on a GET request.
9772
9773 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9774 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9775 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9776 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9777
9778 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9779 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9780 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9781
9782 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9783 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9784 already got a cookie.
9785
9786 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9787 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9788 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9789 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9790 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9791
9792 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9793 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9794 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9795
9796 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9797 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9798 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9799
9800 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9801 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9802
9803 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9804 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9805 then advertised in the response.
9806
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098088.6. Non-printable characters
9809-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009810
9811In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9812consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9813converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9814prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9815being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9816escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9817is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9818'}' when logging headers.
9819
9820Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9821issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9822containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9823
9824Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9825the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9826performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9827
9828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098298.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9830---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009831
9832Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9833achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009834section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009835cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9836the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9837the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009838locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009839not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9840user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9841a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9842wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9843
9844 Examples :
9845 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9846 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9847
9848 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9849 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9850
9851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098528.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9853---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009854
9855Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9856proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9857the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9858server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9859
9860Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9861response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009862section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009863
9864It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009865time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9866appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009867are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9868and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9869follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9870request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9871in the logs.
9872
9873 Example :
9874 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9875 listen proxy-out
9876 mode http
9877 option httplog
9878 option logasap
9879 log global
9880 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9881
9882 # log the name of the virtual server
9883 capture request header Host len 20
9884
9885 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9886 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9887
9888 # log the beginning of the referrer
9889 capture request header Referer len 20
9890
9891 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9892 capture response header Server len 20
9893
9894 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9895 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9896
9897 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9898 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9899
9900 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9901 capture response header Via len 20
9902
9903 # log the URL location during a redirection
9904 capture response header Location len 20
9905
9906 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9907 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9908 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9909 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9910 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9911
9912 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9913 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9914 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9915 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009916 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009917
9918 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9919 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9920 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9921 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9922 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009923 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009924
9925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099268.9. Examples of logs
9927---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009928
9929These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9930them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9931reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9932
9933 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9934 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9935 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9936
9937 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9938 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9939
9940 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9941 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9942 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9943
9944 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9945 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9946
9947 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9948 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9949 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9950
9951 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009952 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009953 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9954 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9955
9956 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9957 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9958 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9959
9960 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9961 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009962 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009963 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9964 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9965 to return the 502 and not the server.
9966
9967 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009968 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009969
9970 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9971 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9972 Nothing was sent to any server.
9973
9974 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9975 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9976
9977 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9978 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9979 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9980 send a 408 return code to the client.
9981
9982 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9983 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9984
9985 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9986 5 seconds ("c----").
9987
9988 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9989 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009990 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009991
9992 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009993 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009994 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9995 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9996 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9997 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9998 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009999
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100019. Statistics and monitoring
10002----------------------------
10003
10004It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10005mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10006CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10007Unix socket.
10008
10009
100109.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010011---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010012
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010013The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10014page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010016 0. pxname: proxy name
10017 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10018 for server)
10019 2. qcur: current queued requests
10020 3. qmax: max queued requests
10021 4. scur: current sessions
10022 5. smax: max sessions
10023 6. slim: sessions limit
10024 7. stot: total sessions
10025 8. bin: bytes in
10026 9. bout: bytes out
10027 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010028 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010029 12. ereq: request errors
10030 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010031 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010032 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10033 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010034 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010035 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10036 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10037 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10038 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10039 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10040 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10041 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10042 25. qlimit: queue limit
10043 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10044 27. iid: unique proxy id
10045 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10046 29. throttle: warm up status
10047 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10048 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010049 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010050 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10051 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10052 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010053 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010054 UNK -> unknown
10055 INI -> initializing
10056 SOCKERR -> socket error
10057 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10058 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10059 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10060 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10061 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10062 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10063 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10064 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10065 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10066 disable-on-404
10067 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10068 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10069 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010070 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10071 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010072 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10073 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10074 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10075 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10076 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10077 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010078 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10079 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10080 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10081 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010082 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10083 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010084
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100869.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010087-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010088
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010089The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010090must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10091is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10092a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10093risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10094followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10095given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10096then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10097to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010098
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010099It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10100on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10101own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010102
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010103clear counters
10104 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10105 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10106 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10107 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10108 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10109
10110clear counters all
10111 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10112 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10113 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10114
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010115clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10116 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10117
10118 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10119 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10120 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10121 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10122 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10123 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10124
10125 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10126
10127 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10128 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10129 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10130 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10131 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10132 the ACLs :
10133
10134 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10135 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10136 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10137 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10138 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10139 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10140
10141 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010142 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10143 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010144
10145 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010146 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010147 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010148 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10149 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10150 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10151 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010152
10153 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10154
10155 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010156 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010157 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10158 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010159 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10160 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10161 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010162
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010163disable frontend <frontend>
10164 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10165 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10166 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10167 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10168 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10169 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10170 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10171 on the stats page.
10172
10173 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10174 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10175
10176 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10177 level "admin".
10178
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010179disable server <backend>/<server>
10180 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10181 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10182 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10183 during the maintenance.
10184
10185 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10186 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10187
10188 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010189 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010190
10191 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10192 level "admin".
10193
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010194enable frontend <frontend>
10195 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10196 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10197 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10198 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10199 which was disabled.
10200
10201 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10202 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10203
10204 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10205 level "admin".
10206
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010207enable server <backend>/<server>
10208 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10209 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10210
10211 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010212 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010213
10214 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10215 level "admin".
10216
10217get weight <backend>/<server>
10218 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10219 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10220 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10221 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10222 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010223 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010224
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010225help
10226 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10227 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010228
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010229prompt
10230 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10231 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10232 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10233 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10234 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10235 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10236 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10237 command.
10238
10239quit
10240 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010241
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010242set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10243 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10244 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10245 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10246 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10247 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10248 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10249 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10250
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010251set maxconn global <maxconn>
10252 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10253 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10254 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10255 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10256 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10257 setting.
10258
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010259set rate-limit connections global <value>
10260 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10261 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10262 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10263 is passed in number of connections per second.
10264
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010265set timeout cli <delay>
10266 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10267 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10268 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10269
10270set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10271 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10272 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10273 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10274 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10275 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10276 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10277 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10278 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10279 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10280 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10281 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10282 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10283 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010284 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010285
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010286show errors [<iid>]
10287 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10288 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010289 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10290 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10291 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010292
10293 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10294 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10295 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10296 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10297 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10298 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10299 are reported too.
10300
10301 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10302 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10303 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10304 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10305 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10306 code.
10307
10308 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10309 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10310 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10311 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10312 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10313 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10314 line.
10315
10316 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010317 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10318 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010319 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10320 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10321
10322 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10323 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10324 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10325 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10326 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10327 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10328 00204+ minal\r\n
10329 00211 \r\n
10330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010331 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010332 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10333 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10334 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10335 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10336 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10337 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010338
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010339show info
10340 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10341
10342show sess
10343 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010344 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10345 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10346
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010347show sess <id>
10348 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10349 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10350 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10351 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10352 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10353 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010354
10355show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10356 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10357 possible to dump only selected items :
10358 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10359 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10360 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10361 for example:
10362 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10363 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10364 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10365
10366 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010367 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10368 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010369 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10370 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10371 Nbproc: 1
10372 Process_num: 1
10373 (...)
10374
10375 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10376 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10377 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10378 (...)
10379 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10380
10381 $
10382
10383 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10384 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10385 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10386 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010387 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010388
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010389show table
10390 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10391 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10392 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10393 entries currently in use.
10394
10395 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010396 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010397 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10398 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010399
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010400show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010401 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10402 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10403 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010404 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10405
10406 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10407 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10408 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10409 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10410 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10411
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010412 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10413 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10414 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10415 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10416 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10417 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10418
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010419
10420 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010421 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10422 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010423
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010424 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010425 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010426 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010427 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10428 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10429 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10430 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010431
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010432 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010433 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010434 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10435 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010436
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010437 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10438 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010439 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010440 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10441 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010442
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010443 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10444 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010445 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010446 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10447 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10448
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010449 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10450 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10451 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10452 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10453 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10454
10455 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10456 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10457 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010458 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10459 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010460 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10461 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010462
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010463shutdown frontend <frontend>
10464 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10465 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10466 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10467 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10468 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10469 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10470 once it is terminated.
10471
10472 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10473 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10474
10475 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10476 level "admin".
10477
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010478shutdown session <id>
10479 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10480 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10481 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10482 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10483 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10484 flag in the logs.
10485
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010486shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10487 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10488 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10489 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10490 'K' flag in the logs.
10491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010492/*
10493 * Local variables:
10494 * fill-column: 79
10495 * End:
10496 */